/* * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * Copyright by The HDF Group. * * All rights reserved. * * * * This file is part of HDF5. The full HDF5 copyright notice, including * * terms governing use, modification, and redistribution, is contained in * * the COPYING file, which can be found at the root of the source code * * distribution tree, or in https://www.hdfgroup.org/licenses. * * If you do not have access to either file, you may request a copy from * * help@hdfgroup.org. * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * */ /* * This file contains function prototypes for each exported function in the * H5P module. */ #ifndef H5Ppublic_H #define H5Ppublic_H /* System headers needed by this file */ /* Public headers needed by this file */ #include "H5public.h" #include "H5ACpublic.h" /* Metadata cache */ #include "H5Dpublic.h" /* Datasets */ #include "H5Fpublic.h" /* Files */ #include "H5FDpublic.h" /* File drivers */ #include "H5Ipublic.h" /* ID management */ #include "H5Lpublic.h" /* Links */ #include "H5MMpublic.h" /* Memory management */ #include "H5Opublic.h" /* Object headers */ #include "H5Spublic.h" /* Dataspaces */ #include "H5Tpublic.h" /* Datatypes */ #include "H5Zpublic.h" /* Data filters */ /*****************/ /* Public Macros */ /*****************/ /* When this header is included from a private HDF5 header, don't make calls to H5open() */ #undef H5OPEN #ifndef H5private_H #define H5OPEN H5open(), #else /* H5private_H */ #define H5OPEN #endif /* H5private_H */ /* * The library's property list classes */ #define H5P_ROOT (H5OPEN H5P_CLS_ROOT_ID_g) #define H5P_OBJECT_CREATE (H5OPEN H5P_CLS_OBJECT_CREATE_ID_g) #define H5P_FILE_CREATE (H5OPEN H5P_CLS_FILE_CREATE_ID_g) #define H5P_FILE_ACCESS (H5OPEN H5P_CLS_FILE_ACCESS_ID_g) #define H5P_DATASET_CREATE (H5OPEN H5P_CLS_DATASET_CREATE_ID_g) #define H5P_DATASET_ACCESS (H5OPEN H5P_CLS_DATASET_ACCESS_ID_g) #define H5P_DATASET_XFER (H5OPEN H5P_CLS_DATASET_XFER_ID_g) #define H5P_FILE_MOUNT (H5OPEN H5P_CLS_FILE_MOUNT_ID_g) #define H5P_GROUP_CREATE (H5OPEN H5P_CLS_GROUP_CREATE_ID_g) #define H5P_GROUP_ACCESS (H5OPEN H5P_CLS_GROUP_ACCESS_ID_g) #define H5P_DATATYPE_CREATE (H5OPEN H5P_CLS_DATATYPE_CREATE_ID_g) #define H5P_DATATYPE_ACCESS (H5OPEN H5P_CLS_DATATYPE_ACCESS_ID_g) #define H5P_MAP_CREATE (H5OPEN H5P_CLS_MAP_CREATE_ID_g) #define H5P_MAP_ACCESS (H5OPEN H5P_CLS_MAP_ACCESS_ID_g) #define H5P_STRING_CREATE (H5OPEN H5P_CLS_STRING_CREATE_ID_g) #define H5P_ATTRIBUTE_CREATE (H5OPEN H5P_CLS_ATTRIBUTE_CREATE_ID_g) #define H5P_ATTRIBUTE_ACCESS (H5OPEN H5P_CLS_ATTRIBUTE_ACCESS_ID_g) #define H5P_OBJECT_COPY (H5OPEN H5P_CLS_OBJECT_COPY_ID_g) #define H5P_LINK_CREATE (H5OPEN H5P_CLS_LINK_CREATE_ID_g) #define H5P_LINK_ACCESS (H5OPEN H5P_CLS_LINK_ACCESS_ID_g) #define H5P_VOL_INITIALIZE (H5OPEN H5P_CLS_VOL_INITIALIZE_ID_g) #define H5P_REFERENCE_ACCESS (H5OPEN H5P_CLS_REFERENCE_ACCESS_ID_g) /* * The library's default property lists */ #define H5P_FILE_CREATE_DEFAULT (H5OPEN H5P_LST_FILE_CREATE_ID_g) #define H5P_FILE_ACCESS_DEFAULT (H5OPEN H5P_LST_FILE_ACCESS_ID_g) #define H5P_DATASET_CREATE_DEFAULT (H5OPEN H5P_LST_DATASET_CREATE_ID_g) #define H5P_DATASET_ACCESS_DEFAULT (H5OPEN H5P_LST_DATASET_ACCESS_ID_g) #define H5P_DATASET_XFER_DEFAULT (H5OPEN H5P_LST_DATASET_XFER_ID_g) #define H5P_FILE_MOUNT_DEFAULT (H5OPEN H5P_LST_FILE_MOUNT_ID_g) #define H5P_GROUP_CREATE_DEFAULT (H5OPEN H5P_LST_GROUP_CREATE_ID_g) #define H5P_GROUP_ACCESS_DEFAULT (H5OPEN H5P_LST_GROUP_ACCESS_ID_g) #define H5P_DATATYPE_CREATE_DEFAULT (H5OPEN H5P_LST_DATATYPE_CREATE_ID_g) #define H5P_DATATYPE_ACCESS_DEFAULT (H5OPEN H5P_LST_DATATYPE_ACCESS_ID_g) #define H5P_MAP_CREATE_DEFAULT (H5OPEN H5P_LST_MAP_CREATE_ID_g) #define H5P_MAP_ACCESS_DEFAULT (H5OPEN H5P_LST_MAP_ACCESS_ID_g) #define H5P_ATTRIBUTE_CREATE_DEFAULT (H5OPEN H5P_LST_ATTRIBUTE_CREATE_ID_g) #define H5P_ATTRIBUTE_ACCESS_DEFAULT (H5OPEN H5P_LST_ATTRIBUTE_ACCESS_ID_g) #define H5P_OBJECT_COPY_DEFAULT (H5OPEN H5P_LST_OBJECT_COPY_ID_g) #define H5P_LINK_CREATE_DEFAULT (H5OPEN H5P_LST_LINK_CREATE_ID_g) #define H5P_LINK_ACCESS_DEFAULT (H5OPEN H5P_LST_LINK_ACCESS_ID_g) #define H5P_VOL_INITIALIZE_DEFAULT (H5OPEN H5P_LST_VOL_INITIALIZE_ID_g) #define H5P_REFERENCE_ACCESS_DEFAULT (H5OPEN H5P_LST_REFERENCE_ACCESS_ID_g) /* Common creation order flags (for links in groups and attributes on objects) */ #define H5P_CRT_ORDER_TRACKED 0x0001 #define H5P_CRT_ORDER_INDEXED 0x0002 /** * Default value of type \ref hid_t for all property list classes */ #define H5P_DEFAULT 0 /* (hid_t) */ #ifdef __cplusplus extern "C" { #endif /*******************/ /* Public Typedefs */ /*******************/ /* Define property list class callback function pointer types */ //! /** * \brief Callback function for H5Pcreate_class() * * \param[in] prop_id The identifier of the property list class being created * \param[in] create_data User pointer to any class creation data required * \return \herr_t * * \details This function is called when a new property list of the class * with which this function was registered is being created. The * function is called after any registered parent create function is * called for each property value. * * If the create function returns a negative value, the new list is not * returned to the user and the property list creation routine returns * an error value. * * \since 1.4.0 * */ typedef herr_t (*H5P_cls_create_func_t)(hid_t prop_id, void *create_data); //! //! /** * \brief Callback function for H5Pcreate_class() * * \param[in] new_prop_id The identifier of the property list copy * \param[in] old_prop_id The identifier of the property list being copied * \param[in] copy_data User pointer to any copy data required * \return \herr_t * * \details This function is called when an existing property list of this * class is copied. The copy callback function is called after any * registered parent copy callback function is called for each property * value. * * If the copy routine returns a negative value, the new list is not * returned to the user and the property list copy function returns an * error value. * * \since 1.4.0 * */ typedef herr_t (*H5P_cls_copy_func_t)(hid_t new_prop_id, hid_t old_prop_id, void *copy_data); //! //! /** * \brief Callback function for H5Pcreate_class() * * \param[in] prop_id The identifier of the property list class being created * \param[in] close_data User pointer to any close data required * \return \herr_t * * \details This function is called when a property list of the class * with which this function was registered is being closed. The * function is called after any registered parent close function is * called for each property value. * * If the close function returns a negative value, the new list is not * returned to the user and the property list close routine returns * an error value. * * \since 1.4.0 * */ typedef herr_t (*H5P_cls_close_func_t)(hid_t prop_id, void *close_data); //! /* Define property list callback function pointer types */ //! /** * \brief Callback function for H5Pregister2(),H5Pregister1(),H5Pinsert2(),H5Pinsert1() * * \param[in] name The name of the property * \param[in] size The size of the property in bytes * \param[in,out] value The value for the property * \return \herr_t * * \details The H5P_prp_cb1_t() function describes the parameters used by the * property create, copy and close callback functions. */ typedef herr_t (*H5P_prp_cb1_t)(const char *name, size_t size, void *value); //! //! /** * \brief Callback function for H5Pregister2(),H5Pregister1(),H5Pinsert2(),H5Pinsert1() * * \plist_id{prop_id} * \param[in] name The name of the property * \param[in] size The size of the property in bytes * \param[in] value The value for the property * \return \herr_t * * \details The H5P_prp_cb2_t() function describes the parameters used by the * property set, copy and delete callback functions. */ typedef herr_t (*H5P_prp_cb2_t)(hid_t prop_id, const char *name, size_t size, void *value); //! typedef H5P_prp_cb1_t H5P_prp_create_func_t; typedef H5P_prp_cb2_t H5P_prp_set_func_t; typedef H5P_prp_cb2_t H5P_prp_get_func_t; //! /** * \brief Callback function for encoding property values * * \param[in] value The property value to be encoded * \param[out] buf The encoded property value * \param[out] size The size of \p buf * \return \herr_t * * \note There is currently no public API which exposes a callback of this type. * */ typedef herr_t (*H5P_prp_encode_func_t)(const void *value, void **buf, size_t *size); //! //! /** * \brief Callback function for decoding property values * * \param[in] buf A buffer containing an encoded property value * \param[out] value The decoded property value * \return \herr_t * * \note There is currently no public API which exposes a callback of this type. * */ typedef herr_t (*H5P_prp_decode_func_t)(const void **buf, void *value); //! typedef H5P_prp_cb2_t H5P_prp_delete_func_t; typedef H5P_prp_cb1_t H5P_prp_copy_func_t; //! /** * \brief Callback function for comparing property values * * \param[in] value1 A property value * \param[in] value2 A property value * \param[in] size The size of the \p value1 and \p value2 buffers * \return Returns a positive value if \c value1 is greater than \c value2, a * negative value if \c value2 is greater than \c value1 and zero if * \c value1 and \c value2 are equal. * * \see H5Pregister(), H5Pinsert() */ typedef int (*H5P_prp_compare_func_t)(const void *value1, const void *value2, size_t size); //! typedef H5P_prp_cb1_t H5P_prp_close_func_t; /* Define property list iteration function type */ //! /** * \brief Callback function for H5Piterate() * * \param[in] id The identifier of a property list or property list class * \param[in] name The name of the current property * \param[in,out] iter_data The user context passed to H5Piterate() * \return \herr_t_iter * * \details This function is called for each property encountered when * iterating over a property list or property list class * via H5Piterate(). * * \since 1.4.0 * */ typedef herr_t (*H5P_iterate_t)(hid_t id, const char *name, void *iter_data); //! //! /** * Actual IO mode property * * \details The default value, #H5D_MPIO_NO_CHUNK_OPTIMIZATION, is used for all * I/O operations that do not use chunk optimizations, including * non-collective I/O and contiguous collective I/O. */ typedef enum H5D_mpio_actual_chunk_opt_mode_t { H5D_MPIO_NO_CHUNK_OPTIMIZATION = 0, /**< No chunk optimization was performed. Either no collective I/O was attempted or the dataset wasn't chunked. */ H5D_MPIO_LINK_CHUNK, /**< Collective I/O is performed on all chunks simultaneously. */ H5D_MPIO_MULTI_CHUNK /**< Each chunk was individually assigned collective or independent I/O based on what fraction of processes access the chunk. If the fraction is greater than the multi chunk ratio threshold, collective I/O is performed on that chunk. The multi chunk ratio threshold can be set using H5Pset_dxpl_mpio_chunk_opt_ratio(). The default value is 60%. */ } H5D_mpio_actual_chunk_opt_mode_t; //! //! /** * The following values are conveniently defined as a bit field so that * we can switch from the default to independent or collective and then to * mixed without having to check the original value. */ typedef enum H5D_mpio_actual_io_mode_t { H5D_MPIO_NO_COLLECTIVE = 0x0, /**< No collective I/O was performed. Collective I/O was not requested or collective I/O isn't possible on this dataset */ H5D_MPIO_CHUNK_INDEPENDENT = 0x1, /**< HDF5 performed one the chunk collective optimization schemes and each chunk was accessed independently */ H5D_MPIO_CHUNK_COLLECTIVE = 0x2, /**< HDF5 performed one the chunk collective optimization schemes and each chunk was accessed collectively */ H5D_MPIO_CHUNK_MIXED = 0x1 | 0x2, /**< HDF5 performed one the chunk collective optimization schemes and some chunks were accessed independently, some collectively. */ /** \internal The contiguous case is separate from the bit field. */ H5D_MPIO_CONTIGUOUS_COLLECTIVE = 0x4 /**< Collective I/O was performed on a contiguous dataset */ } H5D_mpio_actual_io_mode_t; //! //! /** * Broken collective IO property */ typedef enum H5D_mpio_no_collective_cause_t { H5D_MPIO_COLLECTIVE = 0x00, /**< Collective I/O was performed successfully */ H5D_MPIO_SET_INDEPENDENT = 0x01, /**< Collective I/O was not performed because independent I/O was requested */ H5D_MPIO_DATATYPE_CONVERSION = 0x02, /**< Collective I/O was not performed because datatype conversions were required */ H5D_MPIO_DATA_TRANSFORMS = 0x04, /**< Collective I/O was not performed because data transforms needed to be applied */ H5D_MPIO_MPI_OPT_TYPES_ENV_VAR_DISABLED = 0x08, /**< Collective I/O was disabled by environment variable (\Code{HDF5_MPI_OPT_TYPES}) */ H5D_MPIO_NOT_SIMPLE_OR_SCALAR_DATASPACES = 0x10, /**< Collective I/O was not performed because one of the dataspaces was neither simple nor scalar */ H5D_MPIO_NOT_CONTIGUOUS_OR_CHUNKED_DATASET = 0x20, /**< Collective I/O was not performed because the dataset was neither contiguous nor chunked */ H5D_MPIO_PARALLEL_FILTERED_WRITES_DISABLED = 0x40, /**< Collective I/O was not performed because parallel filtered writes are disabled */ H5D_MPIO_ERROR_WHILE_CHECKING_COLLECTIVE_POSSIBLE = 0x80, /**< Error */ H5D_MPIO_NO_COLLECTIVE_MAX_CAUSE = 0x100 /**< Sentinel */ } H5D_mpio_no_collective_cause_t; //! /********************/ /* Public Variables */ /********************/ /* Property list class IDs */ /* (Internal to library, do not use! Use macros above) */ H5_DLLVAR hid_t H5P_CLS_ROOT_ID_g; H5_DLLVAR hid_t H5P_CLS_OBJECT_CREATE_ID_g; H5_DLLVAR hid_t H5P_CLS_FILE_CREATE_ID_g; H5_DLLVAR hid_t H5P_CLS_FILE_ACCESS_ID_g; H5_DLLVAR hid_t H5P_CLS_DATASET_CREATE_ID_g; H5_DLLVAR hid_t H5P_CLS_DATASET_ACCESS_ID_g; H5_DLLVAR hid_t H5P_CLS_DATASET_XFER_ID_g; H5_DLLVAR hid_t H5P_CLS_FILE_MOUNT_ID_g; H5_DLLVAR hid_t H5P_CLS_GROUP_CREATE_ID_g; H5_DLLVAR hid_t H5P_CLS_GROUP_ACCESS_ID_g; H5_DLLVAR hid_t H5P_CLS_DATATYPE_CREATE_ID_g; H5_DLLVAR hid_t H5P_CLS_DATATYPE_ACCESS_ID_g; H5_DLLVAR hid_t H5P_CLS_MAP_CREATE_ID_g; H5_DLLVAR hid_t H5P_CLS_MAP_ACCESS_ID_g; H5_DLLVAR hid_t H5P_CLS_STRING_CREATE_ID_g; H5_DLLVAR hid_t H5P_CLS_ATTRIBUTE_CREATE_ID_g; H5_DLLVAR hid_t H5P_CLS_ATTRIBUTE_ACCESS_ID_g; H5_DLLVAR hid_t H5P_CLS_OBJECT_COPY_ID_g; H5_DLLVAR hid_t H5P_CLS_LINK_CREATE_ID_g; H5_DLLVAR hid_t H5P_CLS_LINK_ACCESS_ID_g; H5_DLLVAR hid_t H5P_CLS_VOL_INITIALIZE_ID_g; H5_DLLVAR hid_t H5P_CLS_REFERENCE_ACCESS_ID_g; /* Default property list IDs */ /* (Internal to library, do not use! Use macros above) */ H5_DLLVAR hid_t H5P_LST_FILE_CREATE_ID_g; H5_DLLVAR hid_t H5P_LST_FILE_ACCESS_ID_g; H5_DLLVAR hid_t H5P_LST_DATASET_CREATE_ID_g; H5_DLLVAR hid_t H5P_LST_DATASET_ACCESS_ID_g; H5_DLLVAR hid_t H5P_LST_DATASET_XFER_ID_g; H5_DLLVAR hid_t H5P_LST_FILE_MOUNT_ID_g; H5_DLLVAR hid_t H5P_LST_GROUP_CREATE_ID_g; H5_DLLVAR hid_t H5P_LST_GROUP_ACCESS_ID_g; H5_DLLVAR hid_t H5P_LST_DATATYPE_CREATE_ID_g; H5_DLLVAR hid_t H5P_LST_DATATYPE_ACCESS_ID_g; H5_DLLVAR hid_t H5P_LST_MAP_CREATE_ID_g; H5_DLLVAR hid_t H5P_LST_MAP_ACCESS_ID_g; H5_DLLVAR hid_t H5P_LST_ATTRIBUTE_CREATE_ID_g; H5_DLLVAR hid_t H5P_LST_ATTRIBUTE_ACCESS_ID_g; H5_DLLVAR hid_t H5P_LST_OBJECT_COPY_ID_g; H5_DLLVAR hid_t H5P_LST_LINK_CREATE_ID_g; H5_DLLVAR hid_t H5P_LST_LINK_ACCESS_ID_g; H5_DLLVAR hid_t H5P_LST_VOL_INITIALIZE_ID_g; H5_DLLVAR hid_t H5P_LST_REFERENCE_ACCESS_ID_g; /*********************/ /* Public Prototypes */ /*********************/ /* Generic property list routines */ /** * \ingroup PLCR * * \brief Terminates access to a property list * * \plist_id * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pclose() terminates access to a property list. All property * lists should be closed when the application is finished * accessing them. This frees resources used by the property * list. * * \since 1.0.0 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pclose(hid_t plist_id); /** * \ingroup PLCRA * * \brief Closes an existing property list class * * \plistcls_id{plist_id} * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pclose_class() removes a property list class from the library. * Existing property lists of this class will continue to exist, * but new ones are not able to be created. * * \since 1.4.0 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pclose_class(hid_t plist_id); /** * \ingroup PLCR * * \brief Copies an existing property list to create a new property list * * \plist_id * * \return \hid_t{property list} * * \details H5Pcopy() copies an existing property list to create a new * property list. The new property list has the same properties * and values as the original property list. * * \since 1.0.0 * */ H5_DLL hid_t H5Pcopy(hid_t plist_id); /** * \ingroup PLCRA * * \brief Copies a property from one list or class to another * * \param[in] dst_id Identifier of the destination property list or class * \param[in] src_id Identifier of the source property list or class * \param[in] name Name of the property to copy * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pcopy_prop() copies a property from one property list or * class to another. * * If a property is copied from one class to another, all the * property information will be first deleted from the destination * class and then the property information will be copied from the * source class into the destination class. * * If a property is copied from one list to another, the property * will be first deleted from the destination list (generating a * call to the close callback for the property, if one exists) * and then the property is copied from the source list to the * destination list (generating a call to the copy callback for * the property, if one exists). * * If the property does not exist in the class or list, this * call is equivalent to calling H5Pregister() or H5Pinsert() (for * a class or list, as appropriate) and the create callback will * be called in the case of the property being copied into a list * (if such a callback exists for the property). * * \since 1.6.0 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pcopy_prop(hid_t dst_id, hid_t src_id, const char *name); /** * \ingroup PLCR * * \brief Creates a new property list as an instance of a property list class * * \plistcls_id{cls_id} * * \return \hid_t{property list} * * \details H5Pcreate() creates a new property list as an instance of * some property list class. The new property list is initialized * with default values for the specified class. The classes are as * follows: * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * *
Class IdentifierClass NameComments
#H5P_ATTRIBUTE_CREATEattribute createProperties for attribute creation
#H5P_DATASET_ACCESSdataset accessProperties for dataset access
#H5P_DATASET_CREATEdataset createProperties for dataset creation
#H5P_DATASET_XFERdata transferProperties for raw data transfer
#H5P_DATATYPE_ACCESSdatatype accessProperties for datatype access
#H5P_DATATYPE_CREATEdatatype createProperties for datatype creation
#H5P_FILE_ACCESSfile accessProperties for file access
#H5P_FILE_CREATEfile createProperties for file creation
#H5P_FILE_MOUNTfile mountProperties for file mounting
#H5P_GROUP_ACCESSgroup accessProperties for group access
#H5P_GROUP_CREATEgroup createProperties for group creation
#H5P_LINK_ACCESSlink accessProperties governing link traversal when accessing objects
#H5P_LINK_CREATElink createProperties governing link creation
#H5P_OBJECT_COPYobject copyProperties governing the object copying process
#H5P_OBJECT_CREATEobject createProperties for object creation
#H5P_STRING_CREATEstring createProperties for character encoding when encoding strings or * object names
#H5P_VOL_INITIALIZEvol initializeProperties for VOL initialization
* * This property list must eventually be closed with H5Pclose(); * otherwise, errors are likely to occur. * * \version 1.12.0 The #H5P_VOL_INITIALIZE property list class was added * \version 1.8.15 For each class, the class name returned by * H5Pget_class_name() was added. * The list of possible Fortran values was updated. * \version 1.8.0 The following property list classes were added at this * release: #H5P_DATASET_ACCESS, #H5P_GROUP_CREATE, * #H5P_GROUP_ACCESS, #H5P_DATATYPE_CREATE, * #H5P_DATATYPE_ACCESS, #H5P_ATTRIBUTE_CREATE * * \since 1.0.0 * */ H5_DLL hid_t H5Pcreate(hid_t cls_id); /** * \ingroup PLCRA * * \brief Creates a new property list class * * \plistcls_id{parent} * \param[in] name Name of property list class to register * \param[in] create Callback routine called when a property list is * created * \param[in] create_data Pointer to user-defined class create data, to be * passed along to class create callback * \param[in] copy Callback routine called when a property list is * copied * \param[in] copy_data Pointer to user-defined class copy data, to be * passed along to class copy callback * \param[in] close Callback routine called when a property list is * being closed * \param[in] close_data Pointer to user-defined class close data, to be * passed along to class close callback * * \return \hid_t{property list class} * * \details H5Pcreate_class() registers a new property list class with the * library. The new property list class can inherit from an * existing property list class, \p parent, or may be derived * from the default “empty” class, NULL. New classes with * inherited properties from existing classes may not remove * those existing properties, only add or remove their own class * properties. Property list classes defined and supported in the * HDF5 library distribution are listed and briefly described in * H5Pcreate(). The \p create, \p copy, \p close functions are called * when a property list of the new class is created, copied, or closed, * respectively. * * H5Pclose_class() must be used to release the property list class * identifier returned by this function. * * \since 1.4.0 * */ H5_DLL hid_t H5Pcreate_class(hid_t parent, const char *name, H5P_cls_create_func_t create, void *create_data, H5P_cls_copy_func_t copy, void *copy_data, H5P_cls_close_func_t close, void *close_data); /** * \ingroup PLCR * * \brief Decodes property list received in a binary object buffer and * returns a new property list identifier * * \param[in] buf Buffer holding the encoded property list * * \return \hid_tv{object} * * \details Given a binary property list description in a buffer, H5Pdecode() * reconstructs the HDF5 property list and returns an identifier * for the new property list. The binary description of the property * list is encoded by H5Pencode(). * * The user is responsible for passing in the correct buffer. * * The property list identifier returned by this function should be * released with H5Pclose() when the identifier is no longer needed * so that resource leaks will not develop. * * \note Some properties cannot be encoded and therefore will not be available * in the decoded property list. These properties are discussed in * H5Pencode(). * * \since 1.10.0 * */ H5_DLL hid_t H5Pdecode(const void *buf); /** * \ingroup PLCR * * \brief Encodes the property values in a property list into a binary * buffer * * \plist_id * \param[out] buf Buffer into which the property list will be encoded. * If the provided buffer is NULL, the size of the * buffer required is returned through \p nalloc; the * function does nothing more. * \param[out] nalloc The size of the required buffer * \fapl_id * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pencode2() encodes the property list \p plist_id into the * binary buffer \p buf, according to the file format setting * specified by the file access property list \p fapl_id. * * If the required buffer size is unknown, \p buf can be passed * in as NULL and the function will set the required buffer size * in \p nalloc. The buffer can then be created and the property * list encoded with a subsequent H5Pencode2() call. * * If the buffer passed in is not big enough to hold the encoded * properties, the H5Pencode2() call can be expected to fail with * a segmentation fault. * * The file access property list \p fapl_id is used to * control the encoding via the \a libver_bounds property * (see H5Pset_libver_bounds()). If the \a libver_bounds * property is missing, H5Pencode2() proceeds as if the \a * libver_bounds property were set to (#H5F_LIBVER_EARLIEST, * #H5F_LIBVER_LATEST). (Functionally, H5Pencode1() is identical to * H5Pencode2() with \a libver_bounds set to (#H5F_LIBVER_EARLIEST, * #H5F_LIBVER_LATEST).) * Properties that do not have encode callbacks will be skipped. * There is currently no mechanism to register an encode callback for * a user-defined property, so user-defined properties cannot currently * be encoded. * * Some properties cannot be encoded, particularly properties that are * reliant on local context. * * \b Motivation: * This function was introduced in HDF5-1.12 as part of the \a H5Sencode * format change to enable 64-bit selection encodings and a dataspace * selection that is tied to a file. * * \since 1.12.0 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pencode2(hid_t plist_id, void *buf, size_t *nalloc, hid_t fapl_id); /** * \ingroup PLCRA * * \brief Compares two property lists or classes for equality * * \param[in] id1 First property object to be compared * \param[in] id2 Second property object to be compared * * \return \htri_t * * \details H5Pequal() compares two property lists or classes to determine * whether they are equal to one another. * * Either both \p id1 and \p id2 must be property lists or both * must be classes; comparing a list to a class is an error. * * \since 1.4.0 * */ H5_DLL htri_t H5Pequal(hid_t id1, hid_t id2); /** * \ingroup PLCRA * * \brief Queries whether a property name exists in a property list or * class * * \param[in] plist_id Identifier for the property list or class to query * \param[in] name Name of property to check for * * \return \htri_t * * \details H5Pexist() determines whether a property exists within a * property list or class. * * \since 1.4.0 * */ H5_DLL htri_t H5Pexist(hid_t plist_id, const char *name); /** * \ingroup PLCRA * * \brief Queries the value of a property * * \plist_id * \param[in] name Name of property to query * \param[out] value Pointer to a location to which to copy the value of * the property * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pget() retrieves a copy of the value for a property in a * property list. If there is a \p get callback routine registered * for this property, the copy of the value of the property will * first be passed to that routine and any changes to the copy of * the value will be used when returning the property value from * this routine. * * This routine may be called for zero-sized properties with the * \p value set to NULL. The \p get routine will be called with * a NULL value if the callback exists. * * The property name must exist or this routine will fail. * * If the \p get callback routine returns an error, \ value will * not be modified. * * \since 1.4.0 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pget(hid_t plist_id, const char *name, void *value); /** * \ingroup PLCR * * \brief Returns the property list class identifier for a property list * * \plist_id * * \return \hid_t{property list class} * * \details H5Pget_class() returns the property list class identifier for * the property list identified by the \p plist_id parameter. * * Note that H5Pget_class() returns a value of #hid_t type, an * internal HDF5 identifier, rather than directly returning a * property list class. That identifier can then be used with * either H5Pequal() or H5Pget_class_name() to determine which * predefined HDF5 property list class H5Pget_class() has returned. * * A full list of valid predefined property list classes appears * in the description of H5Pcreate(). * * Determining the HDF5 property list class name with H5Pequal() * requires a series of H5Pequal() calls in an if-else sequence. * An iterative sequence of H5Pequal() calls can compare the * identifier returned by H5Pget_class() to members of the list of * valid property list class names. A pseudo-code snippet might * read as follows: * * \code * plist_class_id = H5Pget_class (dsetA_plist); * * if H5Pequal (plist_class_id, H5P_OBJECT_CREATE) = TRUE; * [ H5P_OBJECT_CREATE is the property list class ] * [ returned by H5Pget_class. ] * * else if H5Pequal (plist_class_id, H5P_DATASET_CREATE) = TRUE; * [ H5P_DATASET_CREATE is the property list class. ] * * else if H5Pequal (plist_class_id, H5P_DATASET_XFER) = TRUE; * [ H5P_DATASET_XFER is the property list class. ] * * . * . [ Continuing the iteration until a match is found. ] * . * \endcode * * H5Pget_class_name() returns the property list class name directly * as a string: * * \code * plist_class_id = H5Pget_class (dsetA_plist); * plist_class_name = H5Pget_class_name (plist_class_id) * \endcode * * Note that frequent use of H5Pget_class_name() can become a * performance problem in a high-performance environment. The * H5Pequal() approach is generally much faster. * * \version 1.6.0 Return type changed in this release. * \since 1.0.0 * */ H5_DLL hid_t H5Pget_class(hid_t plist_id); /** * \ingroup PLCRA * * \brief Retrieves the name of a class * * \plistcls_id{pclass_id} * * \return Returns a pointer to an allocated string containing the class * name if successful, and NULL if not successful. * * \details H5Pget_class_name() retrieves the name of a generic property * list class. The pointer to the name must be freed by the user * with a call to H5free_memory() after each successful call. * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * *
Class Name (class identifier) ReturnedProperty List ClassExpanded Name of the Property List ClassThe Class Identifier Used with H5PcreateComments
attribute createacplAttribute Creation Property ListH5P_ATTRIBUTE_CREATE
dataset accessdaplDataset Access Property ListH5P_DATASET_ACCESS
dataset createdcplDataset Creation Property ListH5P_DATASET_CREATE
data transferdxplData Transfer Property ListH5P_DATASET_XFER
datatype access H5P_DATATYPE_ACCESSThis class can be created, but there are no properties * in the class currently. *
datatype create H5P_DATATYPE_CREATEThis class can be created, but there * are no properties in the class currently.
file accessfaplFile Access Property ListH5P_FILE_ACCESS
file createfcplFile Creation Property ListH5P_FILE_CREATE
file mountfmplFile Mount Property ListH5P_FILE_MOUNT
group access H5P_GROUP_ACCESSThis class can be created, but there * are no properties in the class currently.
group creategcplGroup Creation Property ListH5P_GROUP_CREATE
link accesslaplLink Access Property ListH5P_LINK_ACCESS
link createlcplLink Creation Property ListH5P_LINK_CREATE
object copyocpyplObject Copy Property ListH5P_OBJECT_COPY
object createocplObject Creation Property ListH5P_OBJECT_CREATE
string createstrcplString Creation Property ListH5P_STRING_CREATE
* * \since 1.4.0 * */ H5_DLL char *H5Pget_class_name(hid_t pclass_id); /** * \ingroup PLCRA * * \brief Retrieves the parent class of a property class * * \plistcls_id{pclass_id} * * \return \hid_t{parent class object} * * \details H5Pget_class_parent() retrieves an identifier for the parent * class of a property class. * * \since 1.4.0 * */ H5_DLL hid_t H5Pget_class_parent(hid_t pclass_id); /** * \ingroup PLCRA * * \brief Queries the number of properties in a property list or class * * \param[in] id Identifier for property object to query * \param[out] nprops Number of properties in object * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pget_nprops() retrieves the number of properties in a * property list or property list class. * * If \p id is a property list identifier, the current number of * properties in the list is returned in \p nprops. * * If \p id is a property list class identifier, the number of * registered properties in the class is returned in \p nprops. * * \since 1.4.0 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pget_nprops(hid_t id, size_t *nprops); /** * \ingroup PLCRA * * \brief Queries the size of a property value in bytes * * \param[in] id Identifier of property object to query * \param[in] name Name of property to query * \param[out] size Size of property in bytes * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pget_size() retrieves the size of a property's value in * bytes. This function operates on both property lists and * property classes. * * Zero-sized properties are allowed and return 0. * * \since 1.4.0 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pget_size(hid_t id, const char *name, size_t *size); /** * \ingroup PLCRA * * \brief Registers a temporary property with a property list * * \plist_id * \param[in] name Name of property to create * \param[in] size Size of property in bytes * \param[in] value Initial value for the property * \param[in] set Callback routine called before a new value is copied * into the property's value * \param[in] get Callback routine called when a property value is * retrieved from the property * \param[in] prp_del Callback routine called when a property is deleted * from a property list * \param[in] copy Callback routine called when a property is copied * from an existing property list * \param[in] compare Callback routine called when a property is compared * with another property list * \param[in] close Callback routine called when a property list is * being closed and the property value will be disposed * of * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pinsert2() creates a new property in a property * list. The property will exist only in this property list and * copies made from it. * * The initial property value must be provided in \p value and * the property value will be set accordingly. * * The name of the property must not already exist in this list, * or this routine will fail. * * The \p set and \p get callback routines may be set to NULL * if they are not needed. * * Zero-sized properties are allowed and do not store any data * in the property list. The default value of a zero-size * property may be set to NULL. They may be used to indicate the * presence or absence of a particular piece of information. * * The \p set routine is called before a new value is copied * into the property. The #H5P_prp_set_func_t callback function * is defined as follows: * \snippet this H5P_prp_cb2_t_snip * * The parameters to the callback function are defined as follows: * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * *
\ref hid_t \c prop_idIN: The identifier of the property list being * modified
\Code{const char * name}IN: The name of the property being modified
\Code{size_t size}IN: The size of the property in bytes
\Code{void * value}IN: Pointer to new value pointer for the property * being modified
* * The \p set routine may modify the value pointer to be set and * those changes will be used when setting the property's value. * If the \p set routine returns a negative value, the new property * value is not copied into the property and the \p set routine * returns an error value. The \p set routine will be called for * the initial value. * * \b Note: The \p set callback function may be useful to range * check the value being set for the property or may perform some * transformation or translation of the value set. The \p get * callback would then reverse the transformation or translation. * A single \p get or \p set callback could handle multiple * properties by performing different actions based on the * property name or other properties in the property list. * * The \p get routine is called when a value is retrieved from * a property value. The #H5P_prp_get_func_t callback function * is defined as follows: * * \snippet this H5P_prp_cb2_t_snip * * The parameters to the above callback function are: * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * *
\ref hid_t \c prop_idIN: The identifier of the property list being queried
\Code{const char * name}IN: The name of the property being queried
\Code{size_t size}IN: The size of the property in bytes
\Code{void * value}IN: The value of the property being returned
* * The \p get routine may modify the value to be returned from * the query and those changes will be preserved. If the \p get * routine returns a negative value, the query routine returns * an error value. * * The \p prp_del routine is called when a property is being * deleted from a property list. The #H5P_prp_delete_func_t * callback function is defined as follows: * * \snippet this H5P_prp_cb2_t_snip * * The parameters to the above callback function are: * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * *
\ref hid_t \c prop_idIN: The identifier of the property list the property is * being deleted from
\Code{const char * name}IN: The name of the property in the list
\Code{size_t size}IN: The size of the property in bytes
\Code{void * value}IN: The value for the property being deleted
* * The \p prp_del routine may modify the value passed in, but the * value is not used by the library when the \p prp_del routine * returns. If the \p prp_del routine returns a negative value, * the property list \p prp_del routine returns an error value but * the property is still deleted. * * The \p copy routine is called when a new property list with * this property is being created through a \p copy operation. * * The #H5P_prp_copy_func_t callback function is defined as follows: * * \snippet this H5P_prp_cb1_t_snip * * The parameters to the above callback function are: * * * * * * * * * * * * * *
\Code{const char * name}IN: The name of the property being copied
\Code{size_t size}IN: The size of the property in bytes
\Code{void * value}IN/OUT: The value for the property being copied
* * The \p copy routine may modify the value to be set and those * changes will be stored as the new value of the property. If the * \p copy routine returns a negative value, the new property value * is not copied into the property and the copy routine returns an * error value. * * The \p compare routine is called when a property list with this * property is compared to another property list with the same * property. * * The #H5P_prp_compare_func_t callback function is defined as * follows: * * \snippet this H5P_prp_compare_func_t_snip * * The parameters to the callback function are defined as follows: * * * * * * * * * * * * * * *
\Code{const void * value1}IN: The value of the first property to compare
\Code{const void * value2}IN: The value of the second property to compare
\Code{size_t size}IN: The size of the property in bytes
* * The \p compare routine may not modify the values. The \p compare * routine should return a positive value if \p value1 is greater * than \p value2, a negative value if \p value2 is greater than * \p value1 and zero if \p value1 and \p value2 are equal. * * The \p close routine is called when a property list with this * property is being closed. * * The #H5P_prp_close_func_t callback function is defined as follows: * \snippet this H5P_prp_cb1_t_snip * * The parameters to the callback function are defined as follows: * * * * * * * * * * * * * * *
\Code{const char * name}IN: The name of the property in the list
\Code{size_t size}IN: The size of the property in bytes
\Code{void * value}IN: The value for the property being closed
* * The \p close routine may modify the value passed in, the * value is not used by the library when the close routine * returns. If the \p close routine returns a negative value, * the property list \p close routine returns an error value * but the property list is still closed. * * \b Note: There is no \p create callback routine for temporary * property list objects; the initial value is assumed to * have any necessary setup already performed on it. * * \since 1.8.0 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pinsert2(hid_t plist_id, const char *name, size_t size, void *value, H5P_prp_set_func_t set, H5P_prp_get_func_t get, H5P_prp_delete_func_t prp_del, H5P_prp_copy_func_t copy, H5P_prp_compare_func_t compare, H5P_prp_close_func_t close); /** * \ingroup PLCRA * * \brief Determines whether a property list is a member of a class * * \plist_id * \plistcls_id{pclass_id} * * \return \htri_t * * \details H5Pisa_class() checks to determine whether the property list * \p plist_id is a member of the property list class * \p pclass_id. * * \see H5Pcreate() * * \since 1.6.0 * */ H5_DLL htri_t H5Pisa_class(hid_t plist_id, hid_t pclass_id); /** * \ingroup PLCRA * * \brief Iterates over properties in a property class or list * * \param[in] id Identifier of property object to iterate over * \param[in,out] idx Index of the property to begin with * \param[in] iter_func Function pointer to function to be called * with each property iterated over * \param[in,out] iter_data Pointer to iteration data from user * * \return On success: the return value of the last call to \p iter_func if * it was non-zero; zero if all properties have been processed. * On Failure, a negative value * * \details H5Piterate() iterates over the properties in the property * object specified in \p id, which may be either a property * list or a property class, performing a specified operation * on each property in turn. * * For each property in the object, \p iter_func and the * additional information specified below are passed to the * #H5P_iterate_t operator function. * * The iteration begins with the \p idx-th property in the * object; the next element to be processed by the operator * is returned in \p idx. If \p idx is NULL, the iterator * starts at the first property; since no stopping point is * returned in this case, the iterator cannot be restarted if * one of the calls to its operator returns non-zero. * * The operation \p iter_func receives the property list or class * identifier for the object being iterated over, \p id, the * name of the current property within the object, \p name, * and the pointer to the operator data passed in to H5Piterate(), * \p iter_data. * * H5Piterate() assumes that the properties in the object * identified by \p id remain unchanged through the iteration. * If the membership changes during the iteration, the function's * behavior is undefined. * * \since 1.4.0 * */ H5_DLL int H5Piterate(hid_t id, int *idx, H5P_iterate_t iter_func, void *iter_data); /** * \ingroup PLCRA * * \brief Registers a permanent property with a property list class * * \plistcls_id{cls_id} * \param[in] name Name of property to register * \param[in] size Size of property in bytes * \param[in] def_value Default value for property in newly created * property lists * \param[in] create Callback routine called when a property list is * being created and the property value will be * initialized * \param[in] set Callback routine called before a new value is * copied into the property's value * \param[in] get Callback routine called when a property value is * retrieved from the property * \param[in] prp_del Callback routine called when a property is deleted * from a property list * \param[in] copy Callback routine called when a property is copied * from a property list * \param[in] compare Callback routine called when a property is compared * with another property list * \param[in] close Callback routine called when a property list is * being closed and the property value will be * disposed of * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pregister2() registers a new property with a property list * class. The \p cls_id identifier can be obtained by calling * H5Pcreate_class(). The property will exist in all property * list objects of \p cl_id created after this routine finishes. The * name of the property must not already exist, or this routine * will fail. The default property value must be provided and all * new property lists created with this property will have the * property value set to the default value. Any of the callback * routines may be set to NULL if they are not needed. * * Zero-sized properties are allowed and do not store any data in * the property list. These may be used as flags to indicate the * presence or absence of a particular piece of information. The * default pointer for a zero-sized property may be set to NULL. * The property \p create and \p close callbacks are called for * zero-sized properties, but the \p set and \p get callbacks are * never called. * * The \p create routine is called when a new property list with * this property is being created. The #H5P_prp_create_func_t * callback function is defined as follows: * * \snippet this H5P_prp_cb1_t_snip * * The parameters to this callback function are defined as follows: * * * * * * * * * * * * * * *
\Code{const char * name}IN: The name of the property being modified
\Code{size_t size}IN: The size of the property in bytes
\Code{void * value}IN/OUT: The default value for the property being created, * which will be passed to H5Pregister2()
* * The \p create routine may modify the value to be set and those * changes will be stored as the initial value of the property. * If the \p create routine returns a negative value, the new * property value is not copied into the property and the * \p create routine returns an error value. * * The \p set routine is called before a new value is copied into * the property. The #H5P_prp_set_func_t callback function is defined * as follows: * * \snippet this H5P_prp_cb2_t_snip * * The parameters to this callback function are defined as follows: * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * *
\ref hid_t \c prop_idIN: The identifier of the property list being modified
\Code{const char * name}IN: The name of the property being modified
\Code{size_t size}IN: The size of the property in bytes
\Code{void *value}IN/OUT: Pointer to new value pointer for the property * being modified
* * The \p set routine may modify the value pointer to be set and * those changes will be used when setting the property's value. * If the \p set routine returns a negative value, the new property * value is not copied into the property and the \p set routine * returns an error value. The \p set routine will not be called * for the initial value; only the \p create routine will be called. * * \b Note: The \p set callback function may be useful to range * check the value being set for the property or may perform some * transformation or translation of the value set. The \p get * callback would then reverse the transformation or translation. * A single \p get or \p set callback could handle multiple * properties by performing different actions based on the property * name or other properties in the property list. * * The \p get routine is called when a value is retrieved from a * property value. The #H5P_prp_get_func_t callback function is * defined as follows: * * \snippet this H5P_prp_cb2_t_snip * * The parameters to the callback function are defined as follows: * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * *
\ref hid_t \c prop_idIN: The identifier of the property list being * queried
\Code{const char * name}IN: The name of the property being queried
\Code{size_t size}IN: The size of the property in bytes
\Code{void * value}IN/OUT: The value of the property being returned
* * The \p get routine may modify the value to be returned from the * query and those changes will be returned to the calling routine. * If the \p set routine returns a negative value, the query * routine returns an error value. * * The \p prp_del routine is called when a property is being * deleted from a property list. The #H5P_prp_delete_func_t * callback function is defined as follows: * * \snippet this H5P_prp_cb2_t_snip * * The parameters to the callback function are defined as follows: * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * *
\ref hid_t \c prop_idIN: The identifier of the property list the property is * being deleted from
\Code{const char * name}IN: The name of the property in the list
\Code{size_t size}IN: The size of the property in bytes
\Code{void * value}IN: The value for the property being deleted
* * The \p prp_del routine may modify the value passed in, but the * value is not used by the library when the \p prp_del routine * returns. If the \p prp_del routine returns a negative value, * the property list delete routine returns an error value but * the property is still deleted. * * The \p copy routine is called when a new property list with * this property is being created through a \p copy operation. * The #H5P_prp_copy_func_t callback function is defined as follows: * * \snippet this H5P_prp_cb1_t_snip * * The parameters to the callback function are defined as follows: * * * * * * * * * * * * * * *
\Code{const char * name}IN: The name of the property being copied
\Code{size_t size}IN: The size of the property in bytes
\Code{void * value}IN/OUT: The value for the property being copied
* * The \p copy routine may modify the value to be set and those * changes will be stored as the new value of the property. If * the \p copy routine returns a negative value, the new * property value is not copied into the property and the \p copy * routine returns an error value. * * The \p compare routine is called when a property list with this * property is compared to another property list with the same * property. The #H5P_prp_compare_func_t callback function is * defined as follows: * * \snippet this H5P_prp_compare_func_t_snip * * The parameters to the callback function are defined as follows: * * * * * * * * * * * * * * *
\Code{const void * value1}IN: The value of the first property to compare
\Code{const void * value2}IN: The value of the second property to compare
\Code{size_t size}IN: The size of the property in bytes
* * The \p compare routine may not modify the values. The \p compare * routine should return a positive value if \p value1 is greater * than \p value2, a negative value if \p value2 is greater than * \p value1 and zero if \p value1 and \p value2 are equal. * * The \p close routine is called when a property list with this * property is being closed. The #H5P_prp_close_func_t callback * function is defined as follows: * * \snippet this H5P_prp_cb1_t_snip * * The parameters to the callback function are defined as follows: * * * * * * * * * * * * * * *
\Code{const char * name}IN: The name of the property in the list
\Code{size_t size}IN: The size of the property in bytes
\Code{void * value}IN: The value for the property being closed
* * The \p close routine may modify the value passed in, but the * value is not used by the library when the \p close routine returns. * If the \p close routine returns a negative value, the property * list close routine returns an error value but the property list is * still closed. * * \since 1.8.0 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pregister2(hid_t cls_id, const char *name, size_t size, void *def_value, H5P_prp_create_func_t create, H5P_prp_set_func_t set, H5P_prp_get_func_t get, H5P_prp_delete_func_t prp_del, H5P_prp_copy_func_t copy, H5P_prp_compare_func_t compare, H5P_prp_close_func_t close); /** * \ingroup PLCRA * * \brief Removes a property from a property list * * \plist_id * \param[in] name Name of property to remove * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Premove() removes a property from a property list. Both * properties which were in existence when the property list was * created (i.e. properties registered with H5Pregister()) and * properties added to the list after it was created (i.e. added * with H5Pinsert1() may be removed from a property list. * Properties do not need to be removed from a property list * before the list itself is closed; they will be released * automatically when H5Pclose() is called. * * If a \p close callback exists for the removed property, it * will be called before the property is released. * * \since 1.4.0 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Premove(hid_t plist_id, const char *name); /** * \ingroup PLCRA * * \brief Sets a property list value * * \plist_id * \param[in] name Name of property to modify * \param[in] value Pointer to value to set the property to * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pset() sets a new value for a property in a property list. * If there is a \p set callback routine registered for this * property, the \p value will be passed to that routine and any * changes to the \p value will be used when setting the property * value. The information pointed to by the \p value pointer * (possibly modified by the \p set callback) is copied into the * property list value and may be changed by the application * making the H5Pset() call without affecting the property value. * * The property name must exist or this routine will fail. * * If the \p set callback routine returns an error, the property * value will not be modified. * * This routine may not be called for zero-sized properties and * will return an error in that case. * * \since 1.4.0 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pset(hid_t plist_id, const char *name, const void *value); /** * \ingroup PLCRA * * \brief Removes a property from a property list class * * \plistcls_id{pclass_id} * \param[in] name Name of property to remove * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Punregister() removes a property from a property list class. * Future property lists created of that class will not contain * this property; existing property lists containing this property * are not affected. * * \since 1.4.0 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Punregister(hid_t pclass_id, const char *name); /** * \ingroup DCPL * * \brief Verifies that all required filters are available * * \plist_id * * \return \htri_t * * \details H5Pall_filters_avail() verifies that all of the filters set in * the dataset or group creation property list \p plist_id are * currently available. * * \version 1.8.5 Function extended to work with group creation property * lists. * \since 1.6.0 * */ H5_DLL htri_t H5Pall_filters_avail(hid_t plist_id); /* Object creation property list (OCPL) routines */ /** * \ingroup OCPL * * \brief Retrieves tracking and indexing settings for attribute creation * order * * \plist_id * \param[out] crt_order_flags Flags specifying whether to track and * index attribute creation order * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pget_attr_creation_order() retrieves the settings for * tracking and indexing attribute creation order on an object. * * \p plist_id is an object creation property list (\p ocpl), * as it can be a dataset or group creation property list * identifier. The term \p ocpl is used when different types * of objects may be involved. * * \p crt_order_flags returns flags with the following meanings: * * * * * * * * * * *
#H5P_CRT_ORDER_TRACKEDAttribute creation order is tracked but not necessarily * indexed.
#H5P_CRT_ORDER_INDEXED Attribute creation order is indexed (requires * #H5P_CRT_ORDER_TRACKED).
* * If \p crt_order_flags is returned with a value of 0 (zero), * attribute creation order is neither tracked nor indexed. * * \since 1.8.0 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pget_attr_creation_order(hid_t plist_id, unsigned *crt_order_flags); /** * \ingroup OCPL * * \brief Retrieves attribute storage phase change thresholds * * \plist_id * \param[out] max_compact Maximum number of attributes to be stored in * compact storage (Default: 8) * \param[out] min_dense Minimum number of attributes to be stored in * dense storage (Default: 6) * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pget_attr_phase_change() retrieves threshold values for * attribute storage on an object. These thresholds determine the * point at which attribute storage changes from compact storage * (i.e., storage in the object header) to dense storage (i.e., * storage in a heap and indexed with a B-tree). * * In the general case, attributes are initially kept in compact * storage. When the number of attributes exceeds \p max_compact, * attribute storage switches to dense storage. If the number of * attributes subsequently falls below \p min_dense, the * attributes are returned to compact storage. * * If \p max_compact is set to 0 (zero), dense storage always used. * * \p plist_id is an object creation property list (\p ocpl), as it * can be a dataset or group creation property list identifier. * The term \p ocpl is used when different types of objects may be * involved. * * \since 1.8.0 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pget_attr_phase_change(hid_t plist_id, unsigned *max_compact, unsigned *min_dense); /** * \ingroup OCPL * * \brief Returns information about a filter in a pipeline * * \ocpl_id{plist_id} * \param[in] idx Sequence number within the filter pipeline of the filter * for which information is sought * \param[out] flags Bit vector specifying certain general properties of the * filter * \param[in,out] cd_nelmts Number of elements in \p cd_values * \param[out] cd_values Auxiliary data for the filter * \param[in] namelen Anticipated number of characters in \p name * \param[out] name Name of the filter * \param[out] filter_config Bit field, as described in H5Zget_filter_info() * * \return Returns a negative value on failure, and the filter identifier * if successful (see #H5Z_filter_t): * - #H5Z_FILTER_DEFLATE Data compression filter, * employing the gzip algorithm * - #H5Z_FILTER_SHUFFLE Data shuffling filter * - #H5Z_FILTER_FLETCHER32 Error detection filter, employing the * Fletcher32 checksum algorithm * - #H5Z_FILTER_SZIP Data compression filter, employing the * SZIP algorithm * - #H5Z_FILTER_NBIT Data compression filter, employing the * N-bit algorithm * - #H5Z_FILTER_SCALEOFFSET Data compression filter, employing the * scale-offset algorithm * * \details H5Pget_filter2() returns information about a filter specified by * its filter number, in a filter pipeline specified by the property * list with which it is associated. * * \p plist_id must be a dataset or group creation property list. * * \p idx is a value between zero and N-1, as described in * H5Pget_nfilters(). The function will return a negative value if * the filter number is out of range. * * The structure of the \p flags argument is discussed in * H5Pset_filter(). * * On input, \p cd_nelmts indicates the number of entries in the * \p cd_values array, as allocated by the caller; on return, * \p cd_nelmts contains the number of values defined by the filter. * * If \p name is a pointer to an array of at least \p namelen bytes, * the filter name will be copied into that array. The name will be * null terminated if \p namelen is large enough. The filter name * returned will be the name appearing in the file, the name * registered for the filter, or an empty string. * * \p filter_config is the bit field described in * H5Zget_filter_info(). * * \version 1.8.5 Function extended to work with group creation property * lists. * \since 1.8.0 * */ H5_DLL H5Z_filter_t H5Pget_filter2(hid_t plist_id, unsigned idx, unsigned int *flags /*out*/, size_t *cd_nelmts /*out*/, unsigned cd_values[] /*out*/, size_t namelen, char name[], unsigned *filter_config /*out*/); /** * \ingroup OCPL * * \brief Returns information about the specified filter * * \ocpl_id{plist_id} * \param[in] filter_id Filter identifier * \param[out] flags Bit vector specifying certain general * properties of the filter * \param[in,out] cd_nelmts Number of elements in \p cd_values * \param[out] cd_values[] Auxiliary data for the filter * \param[in] namelen Length of filter name and number of * elements in \p name * \param[out] name[] Name of filter * \param[out] filter_config Bit field, as described in * H5Zget_filter_info() * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pget_filter_by_id2() returns information about the filter * specified in \p filter_id, a filter identifier. * * \p plist_id must be a dataset or group creation property list * and \p filter_id must be in the associated filter pipeline. * * The \p filter_id and \p flags parameters are used in the same * manner as described in the discussion of H5Pset_filter(). * * Aside from the fact that they are used for output, the * parameters \p cd_nelmts and \p cd_values[] are used in the same * manner as described in the discussion of H5Pset_filter(). On * input, the \p cd_nelmts parameter indicates the number of * entries in the \p cd_values[] array allocated by the calling * program; on exit it contains the number of values defined by * the filter. * * On input, the \p namelen parameter indicates the number of * characters allocated for the filter name by the calling program * in the array \p name[]. On exit \p name[] contains the name of the * filter with one character of the name in each element of the * array. * * \p filter_config is the bit field described in * H5Zget_filter_info(). * * If the filter specified in \p filter_id is not set for the * property list, an error will be returned and * H5Pget_filter_by_id2() will fail. * * \version 1.8.5 Function extended to work with group creation property * lists. * * \since 1.8.0 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pget_filter_by_id2(hid_t plist_id, H5Z_filter_t filter_id, unsigned int *flags /*out*/, size_t *cd_nelmts /*out*/, unsigned cd_values[] /*out*/, size_t namelen, char name[] /*out*/, unsigned *filter_config /*out*/); /** * \ingroup OCPL * * \brief Returns the number of filters in the pipeline * * \ocpl_id{plist_id} * * \return Returns the number of filters in the pipeline if successful; * otherwise returns a negative value. * * \details H5Pget_nfilters() returns the number of filters defined in the * filter pipeline associated with the property list \p plist_id. * * In each pipeline, the filters are numbered from 0 through \Code{N-1}, * where \c N is the value returned by this function. During output to * the file, the filters are applied in increasing order; during * input from the file, they are applied in decreasing order. * * H5Pget_nfilters() returns the number of filters in the pipeline, * including zero (0) if there are none. * * \since 1.0.0 * */ H5_DLL int H5Pget_nfilters(hid_t plist_id); /** * \ingroup OCPL * * \brief Determines whether times associated with an object * are being recorded * * \plist_id * \param[out] track_times Boolean value, 1 (TRUE) or 0 (FALSE), * specifying whether object times are being recorded * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pget_obj_track_times() queries the object creation property * list, \p plist_id, to determine whether object times are being * recorded. * * If \p track_times is returned as 1, times are being recorded; * if \p track_times is returned as 0, times are not being * recorded. * * Time data can be retrieved with H5Oget_info(), which will return * it in the #H5O_info_t struct. * * If times are not tracked, they will be reported as follows * when queried: 12:00 AM UDT, Jan. 1, 1970 * * See H5Pset_obj_track_times() for further discussion. * * \since 1.8.0 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pget_obj_track_times(hid_t plist_id, hbool_t *track_times); /** * \ingroup OCPL * * \brief Modifies a filter in the filter pipeline * * \ocpl_id{plist_id} * \param[in] filter Filter to be modified * \param[in] flags Bit vector specifying certain general properties * of the filter * \param[in] cd_nelmts Number of elements in \p cd_values * \param[in] cd_values[] Auxiliary data for the filter * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pmodify_filter() modifies the specified \p filter in the * filter pipeline. \p plist_id must be a dataset or group * creation property list. * * The \p filter, \p flags \p cd_nelmts[], and \p cd_values * parameters are used in the same manner and accept the same * values as described in the discussion of H5Pset_filter(). * * \version 1.8.5 Function extended to work with group creation property * lists. * \since 1.6.0 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pmodify_filter(hid_t plist_id, H5Z_filter_t filter, unsigned int flags, size_t cd_nelmts, const unsigned int cd_values[/*cd_nelmts*/]); /** * \ingroup OCPL * * \brief Delete one or more filters in the filter pipeline * * \ocpl_id{plist_id} * \param[in] filter Filter to be deleted * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Premove_filter() removes the specified \p filter from the * filter pipeline in the dataset or group creation property * list \p plist_id. * * The \p filter parameter specifies the filter to be removed. * Valid values for use in \p filter are as follows: * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * *
#H5Z_FILTER_ALLRemoves all filters from the filter pipeline
#H5Z_FILTER_DEFLATEData compression filter, employing the gzip * algorithm
#H5Z_FILTER_SHUFFLEData shuffling filter
#H5Z_FILTER_FLETCHER32Error detection filter, employing the Fletcher32 * checksum algorithm
#H5Z_FILTER_SZIPData compression filter, employing the SZIP * algorithm
#H5Z_FILTER_NBITData compression filter, employing the N-Bit * algorithm
#H5Z_FILTER_SCALEOFFSETData compression filter, employing the scale-offset * algorithm
* * Additionally, user-defined filters can be removed with this * routine by passing the filter identifier with which they were * registered with the HDF5 library. * * Attempting to remove a filter that is not in the filter * pipeline is an error. * * \version 1.8.5 Function extended to work with group creation property * lists. * \since 1.6.3 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Premove_filter(hid_t plist_id, H5Z_filter_t filter); /** * \ingroup OCPL * * \brief Sets tracking and indexing of attribute creation order * * \plist_id * \param[in] crt_order_flags Flags specifying whether to track and index * attribute creation order. \em Default: No * flag set; attribute creation order is neither * tracked not indexed * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pset_attr_creation_order() sets flags for tracking and * indexing attribute creation order on an object. * * \p plist_id is a dataset or group creation property list * identifier. * * \p crt_order_flags contains flags with the following meanings: * * * * * * * * * * *
#H5P_CRT_ORDER_TRACKEDAttribute creation order is tracked but not necessarily * indexed.
#H5P_CRT_ORDER_INDEXED Attribute creation order is indexed (requires * #H5P_CRT_ORDER_TRACKED).
* * Default behavior is that attribute creation order is neither * tracked nor indexed. * * H5Pset_attr_creation_order() can be used to set attribute * creation order tracking, or to set attribute creation order * tracking and indexing. * * \note If a creation order index is to be built, it must be specified in * the object creation property list. HDF5 currently provides no * mechanism to turn on attribute creation order tracking at object * creation time and to build the index later. * * \since 1.8.0 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pset_attr_creation_order(hid_t plist_id, unsigned crt_order_flags); /** * \ingroup OCPL * * \brief Sets attribute storage phase change thresholds * * \plist_id * \param[in] max_compact Maximum number of attributes to be stored in * compact storage (\em Default: 8); must be greater * than or equal to \p min_dense * * \param[in] min_dense Minimum number of attributes to be stored in * dense storage (\em Default: 6) * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pset_attr_phase_change() sets threshold values for attribute * storage on an object. These thresholds determine the point at * which attribute storage changes from compact storage (i.e., * storage in the object header) to dense storage (i.e., storage * in a heap and indexed with a B-tree). * * In the general case, attributes are initially kept in compact * storage. When the number of attributes exceeds \p max_compact, * attribute storage switches to dense storage. If the number of * attributes subsequently falls below \p min_dense, the attributes * are returned to compact storage. * * If \p max_compact is set to 0 (zero), dense storage is always * used. \p min_dense must be set to 0 (zero) when \p max_compact * is 0 (zero). * * \p plist_id is a dataset or group creation property list * identifier. * * \since 1.8.0 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pset_attr_phase_change(hid_t plist_id, unsigned max_compact, unsigned min_dense); /** * \ingroup DCPL * * \brief Sets deflate (GNU gzip) compression method and compression level * * \ocpl_id{plist_id} * \param[in] level Compression level * * \return \herr_t * * \par_compr_note * * \details H5Pset_deflate() sets the deflate compression method and the * compression level, \p level, for a dataset or group creation * property list, \p plist_id. * * The filter identifier set in the property list is * #H5Z_FILTER_DEFLATE. * * The compression level, \p level, is a value from zero to nine, * inclusive. A compression level of 0 (zero) indicates no * compression; compression improves but speed slows progressively * from levels 1 through 9: * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * *
Compression LevelGzip Action
0No compression
1Best compression speed; least compression
2 through 8Compression improves; speed degrades
9Best compression ratio; slowest speed
* * Note that setting the compression level to 0 (zero) does not turn * off use of the gzip filter; it simply sets the filter to perform * no compression as it processes the data. * * HDF5 relies on GNU gzip for this compression. * * \version 1.8.5 Function extended to work with group creation property lists. * \since 1.0.0 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pset_deflate(hid_t plist_id, unsigned level); /** * \ingroup OCPL * * \brief Adds a filter to the filter pipeline * * \ocpl_id{plist_id} * \param[in] filter Filter identifier for the filter to be added to the * pipeline * \param[in] flags Bit vector specifying certain general properties of * the filter * \param[in] cd_nelmts Number of elements in \p c_values * \param[in] c_values Auxiliary data for the filter * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pset_filter() adds the specified \p filter identifier and * corresponding properties to the end of an output filter * pipeline. * * \p plist_id must be either a dataset creation property list or * group creation property list identifier. If \p plist_id is a * dataset creation property list identifier, the filter is added * to the raw data filter pipeline. * * If \p plist_id is a group creation property list identifier, * the filter is added to the link filter pipeline, which filters * the fractal heap used to store most of the link metadata in * certain types of groups. The only predefined filters that can * be set in a group creation property list are the gzip filter * (#H5Z_FILTER_DEFLATE) and the Fletcher32 error detection filter * (#H5Z_FILTER_FLETCHER32). * * The array \p c_values contains \p cd_nelmts integers which are * auxiliary data for the filter. The integer values will be * stored in the dataset object header as part of the filter * information. * * The \p flags argument is a bit vector with the following * fields specifying certain general properties of the filter: * * * * * * * * * * *
#H5Z_FLAG_OPTIONALIf this bit is set then the filter is optional. If the * filter fails (see below) during an H5Dwrite() operation * then the filter is just excluded from the pipeline for * the chunk for which it failed; the filter will not * participate in the pipeline during an H5Dread() of the * chunk. This is commonly used for compression filters: * if the filter result would be larger than the input, * then the compression filter returns failure and the * uncompressed data is stored in the file.

* This flag should not be set for the Fletcher32 checksum * filter as it will bypass the checksum filter without * reporting checksum errors to an application.
#H5Z_FLAG_MANDATORYIf the filter is required, that is, set to mandatory, * and the filter fails, the library’s behavior depends * on whether the chunk cache is in use: * \li If the chunk cache is enabled, data chunks will * be flushed to the file during H5Dclose() and the * library will return the failure in H5Dclose(). * \li When the chunk cache is disabled or not big enough, * or the chunk is being evicted from the cache, the * failure will happen during H5Dwrite(). * * In each case, the library will still write to the file * all data chunks that were processed by the filter * before the failure occurred.

* For example, assume that an application creates a * dataset of four chunks, the chunk cache is enabled and * is big enough to hold all four chunks, and the filter * fails when it tries to write the fourth chunk. The * actual flush of the chunks will happen during * H5Dclose(), not H5Dwrite(). By the time H5Dclose() * fails, the first three chunks will have been written * to the file. Even though H5Dclose() fails, all the * resources will be released and the file can be closed * properly.

* If, however, the filter fails on the second chunk, only * the first chunk will be written to the file as nothing * further can be written once the filter fails.
* The \p filter parameter specifies the filter to be set. Valid * pre-defined filter identifiers are as follows: * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * *
#H5Z_FILTER_DEFLATEData compression filter, employing the gzip * algorithm
#H5Z_FILTER_SHUFFLEData shuffling filter
#H5Z_FILTER_FLETCHER32Error detection filter, employing the Fletcher32 * checksum algorithm
#H5Z_FILTER_SZIPData compression filter, employing the SZIP * algorithm
#H5Z_FILTER_NBITData compression filter, employing the N-Bit * algorithm
#H5Z_FILTER_SCALEOFFSETData compression filter, employing the scale-offset * algorithm
* Also see H5Pset_edc_check() and H5Pset_filter_callback(). * * \note When a non-empty filter pipeline is used with a group creation * property list, the group will be created with the new group file * format. The filters will come into play only when dense storage * is used (see H5Pset_link_phase_change()) and will be applied to * the group’s fractal heap. The fractal heap will contain most of * the the group’s link metadata, including link names. * * \note When working with group creation property lists, if you are * adding a filter that is not in HDF5’s set of predefined filters, * i.e., a user-defined or third-party filter, you must first * determine that the filter will work for a group. See the * discussion of the set local and can apply callback functions * in H5Zregister(). * * \note If multiple filters are set for a property list, they will be * applied to each chunk of raw data for datasets or each block * of the fractal heap for groups in the order in which they were * set. * * \note Filters can be applied only to chunked datasets; they cannot be * used with other dataset storage methods, such as contiguous, * compact, or external datasets. * * \note Dataset elements of variable-length and dataset region * reference datatypes are stored in separate structures in the * file called heaps. Filters cannot currently be applied to * these heaps. * * \note Filter Behavior in HDF5:
* Filters can be inserted into the HDF5 pipeline to perform * functions such as compression and conversion. As such, they are * a very flexible aspect of HDF5; for example, a user-defined * filter could provide encryption for an HDF5 dataset. * * \note A filter can be declared as either required or optional. * Required is the default status; optional status must be * explicitly declared. * * \note A required filter that fails or is not defined causes an * entire output operation to fail; if it was applied when the * data was written, such a filter will cause an input operation * to fail. * * \note The following table summarizes required filter behavior. * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * *
Required FILTER_X not availableFILTER_X available
H5Pset_Will fail.Will succeed.
H5Dwrite with FILTER_X setWill fail.Will succeed; FILTER_X will be applied to * the data.
H5Dread with FILTER_X setWill fail.Will succeed.
* \note An optional filter can be set for an HDF5 dataset even when * the filter is not available. Such a filter can then be * applied to the dataset when it becomes available on the * original system or when the file containing the dataset is * processed on a system on which it is available. * * \note A filter can be declared as optional through the use of the * #H5Z_FLAG_OPTIONAL flag with H5Pset_filter(). * * \note Consider a situation where one is creating files that will * normally be used only on systems where the optional (and * fictional) filter FILTER_Z is routinely available. One can * create those files on system A, which lacks FILTER_Z, create * chunked datasets in the files with FILTER_Z defined in the * dataset creation property list, and even write data to those * datasets. The dataset object header will indicate that FILTER_Z * has been associated with this dataset. But since system A does * not have FILTER_Z, dataset chunks will be written without it * being applied. * * \note HDF5 has a mechanism for determining whether chunks are * actually written with the filters specified in the object * header, so while the filter remains unavailable, system A will * be able to read the data. Once the file is moved to system B, * where FILTER_Z is available, HDF5 will apply FILTER_Z to any * data rewritten or new data written in these datasets. Dataset * chunks that have been written on system B will then be * unreadable on system A; chunks that have not been re-written * since being written on system A will remain readable on system * A. All chunks will be readable on system B. * * \note The following table summarizes optional filter behavior. * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * *
FILTER_Z not availableFILTER_Z available
with encode and decode
FILTER_Z available decode only
H5Pset_Will succeed.Will succeed.Will succeed.
H5Dread with FILTER_Z setWill succeed if FILTER_Z has not actually
* been applied to data.
Will succeed.Will succeed.
H5Dwrite with FILTER_Z setWill succeed;
* FILTER_Z will not be applied to the data.
Will succeed;
* FILTER_Z will be applied to the data.
Will succeed;
* FILTER_Z will not be applied to the data.
* \note The above principles apply generally in the use of HDF5 * optional filters insofar as HDF5 does as much as possible to * complete an operation when an optional filter is unavailable. * (The SZIP filter is an exception to this rule; see H5Pset_szip() * for details.) * * \see \ref_filter_pipe, \ref_group_impls * * \version 1.8.5 Function applied to group creation property lists. * \since 1.6.0 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pset_filter(hid_t plist_id, H5Z_filter_t filter, unsigned int flags, size_t cd_nelmts, const unsigned int c_values[]); /** * \ingroup OCPL * * \brief Sets up use of the Fletcher32 checksum filter * * \ocpl_id{plist_id} * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pset_fletcher32() sets the Fletcher32 checksum filter in the * dataset or group creation property list \p plist_id. * * \attention The Fletcher32 EDC checksum filter was added in HDF5 Release * 1.6.0. In the original implementation, however, the checksum * value was calculated incorrectly on little-endian systems. * The error was fixed in HDF5 Release 1.6.3. * * \attention As a result of this fix, an HDF5 library of Release 1.6.0 * through Release 1.6.2 cannot read a dataset created or written * with Release 1.6.3 or later if the dataset was created with * the checksum filter and the filter is enabled in the reading * library. (Libraries of Release 1.6.3 and later understand the * earlier error and compensate appropriately.) * * \attention \b Work-around: An HDF5 library of Release 1.6.2 or earlier * will be able to read a dataset created or written with the * checksum filter by an HDF5 library of Release 1.6.3 or later * if the checksum filter is disabled for the read operation. * This can be accomplished via a call to H5Pset_edc_check() * with the value #H5Z_DISABLE_EDC in the second parameter. * This has the obvious drawback that the application will be * unable to verify the checksum, but the data does remain * accessible. * * \version 1.8.5 Function extended to work with group creation property * lists. * \version 1.6.3 Error in checksum calculation on little-endian systems * corrected in this release. * \since 1.6.0 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pset_fletcher32(hid_t plist_id); /** * \ingroup OCPL * * \brief Sets the recording of times associated with an object * * \param[in] plist_id Object creation property list identifier * \param[in] track_times Boolean value, 1 or 0, specifying whether object * times are to be tracked * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pset_obj_track_times() sets a property in the object creation * property list, \p plist_id, that governs the recording of times * associated with an object. * * If \p track_times is set to 1, time data will be recorded. If * \p track_times is set to 0, time data will not be recorded. * * Time data can be retrieved with H5Oget_info(), which will * return it in the #H5O_info_t struct. * * If times are not tracked, they will be reported as follows when queried: * \Code{ 12:00 AM UDT, Jan. 1, 1970} * * That date and time are commonly used to represent the beginning of the UNIX epoch. * * \since 1.8.0 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pset_obj_track_times(hid_t plist_id, hbool_t track_times); /* File creation property list (FCPL) routines */ /** * \ingroup FCPL * * \brief Retrieves the file space page size for a file creation property * list * * \fcpl_id{plist_id} * \param[out] fsp_size File space page size * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pget_file_space_page_size() retrieves the file space page * size for paged aggregation in the parameter \p fsp_size. * * The library default is 4KB (4096) if \p fsp_size is not * previously set via a call to H5Pset_file_space_page_size(). * * \since 1.10.1 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pget_file_space_page_size(hid_t plist_id, hsize_t *fsp_size); /** * \ingroup FCPL * * \brief Retrieves the file space handling strategy, persisting free-space * condition and threshold value for a file creation property list * * \fcpl_id{plist_id} * \param[out] strategy The file space handling strategy * \param[out] persist The boolean value indicating whether free space is * persistent or not * \param[out] threshold The free-space section size threshold value * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pget_file_space_strategy() retrieves the file space handling * strategy, the persisting free-space condition and the threshold * value in the parameters \p strategy, \p persist and * \p threshold respectively. * * The library default values returned when * H5Pset_file_space_strategy() has not been called are: * * \li \p strategy - #H5F_FSPACE_STRATEGY_FSM_AGGR * \li \p persist - 0 * \li \p threshold - 1 * * \since 1.10.1 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pget_file_space_strategy(hid_t plist_id, H5F_fspace_strategy_t *strategy, hbool_t *persist, hsize_t *threshold); /** * \ingroup FCPL * * \brief Queries the 1/2 rank of an indexed storage B-tree * * \fcpl_id{plist_id} * \param[out] ik Pointer to location to return the chunked storage B-tree * 1/2 rank (Default value of B-tree 1/2 rank: 32) * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pget_istore_k() queries the 1/2 rank of an indexed storage * B-tree. * * The argument \p ik may be the null pointer (NULL). * This function is valid only for file creation property lists. * * \see H5Pset_istore_k() * * \version 1.6.4 \p ik parameter type changed to \em unsigned. * \since 1.0.0 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pget_istore_k(hid_t plist_id, unsigned *ik /*out*/); /** * \ingroup FCPL * * \brief Retrieves the configuration settings for a shared message index * * \fcpl_id{plist_id} * \param[in] index_num Index being configured * \param[out] mesg_type_flags Types of messages that may be stored in * this index * \param[out] min_mesg_size Minimum message size * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pget_shared_mesg_index() retrieves the message type and * minimum message size settings from the file creation property * list \p plist_id for the shared object header message index * specified by \p index_num. * * \p index_num specifies the index. \p index_num is zero-indexed, * so in a file with three indexes, they will be numbered 0, 1, * and 2. * * \p mesg_type_flags and \p min_mesg_size will contain, * respectively, the types of messages and the minimum size, in * bytes, of messages that can be stored in this index. * * Valid message types are described in H5Pset_shared_mesg_index(). * * \since 1.8.0 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pget_shared_mesg_index(hid_t plist_id, unsigned index_num, unsigned *mesg_type_flags, unsigned *min_mesg_size); /** * \ingroup FCPL * * \brief Retrieves the number of shared object header message indexes in file * creation property list * * \fcpl_id{plist_id} * \param[out] nindexes Number of shared object header message indexes * available in files created with this property list * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pget_shared_mesg_nindexes() retrieves the number of shared * object header message indexes in the specified file creation * property list \p plist_id. * * If the value of \p nindexes is 0 (zero), shared object header * messages are disabled in files created with this property list. * * \since 1.8.0 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pget_shared_mesg_nindexes(hid_t plist_id, unsigned *nindexes); /** * \ingroup FCPL * * \brief Retrieves shared object header message phase change information * * \fcpl_id{plist_id} * \param[out] max_list Threshold above which storage of a shared object * header message index shifts from list to B-tree * \param[out] min_btree Threshold below which storage of a shared object * header message index reverts to list format * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pget_shared_mesg_phase_change() retrieves the threshold values * for storage of shared object header message indexes in a file. * These phase change thresholds determine the point at which the * index storage mechanism changes from a more compact list format * to a more performance-oriented B-tree format, and vice-versa. * * By default, a shared object header message index is initially * stored as a compact list. When the number of messages in an * index exceeds the specified \p max_list threshold, storage * switches to a B-tree format for improved performance. If the * number of messages subsequently falls below the \p min_btree * threshold, the index will revert to the list format. * * If \p max_list is set to 0 (zero), shared object header message * indexes in the file will always be stored as B-trees. * * \p plist_id specifies the file creation property list. * * \since 1.8.0 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pget_shared_mesg_phase_change(hid_t plist_id, unsigned *max_list, unsigned *min_btree); /** * \ingroup FCPL * * \brief Retrieves the size of the offsets and lengths used in an HDF5 * file * * \fcpl_id{plist_id} * \param[out] sizeof_addr Pointer to location to return offset size in * bytes * \param[out] sizeof_size Pointer to location to return length size in * bytes * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pget_sizes() retrieves the size of the offsets and lengths * used in an HDF5 file. This function is only valid for file * creation property lists. * * \since 1.0.0 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pget_sizes(hid_t plist_id, size_t *sizeof_addr /*out*/, size_t *sizeof_size /*out*/); /** * \ingroup FCPL * * \brief Retrieves the size of the symbol table B-tree 1/2 rank and the * symbol table leaf node 1/2 size * * \fcpl_id{plist_id} * \param[out] ik Pointer to location to return the symbol table's B-tree * 1/2 rank (Default value of B-tree 1/2 rank: 16) * \param[out] lk Pointer to location to return the symbol table's leaf * node 1/2 size (Default value of leaf node 1/2 * size: 4) * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pget_sym_k() retrieves the size of the symbol table B-tree * 1/2 rank and the symbol table leaf node 1/2 size. * * This function is valid only for file creation property lists. * * If a parameter value is set to NULL, that parameter is not * retrieved. * * \see H5Pset_sym_k() * * \version 1.6.4 \p ik parameter type changed to \em unsigned * \version 1.6.0 The \p ik parameter has changed from type int to * \em unsigned * * \since 1.0.0 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pget_sym_k(hid_t plist_id, unsigned *ik /*out*/, unsigned *lk /*out*/); /** * \ingroup FCPL * * \brief Retrieves the size of a user block * * \fcpl_id{plist_id} * \param[out] size Pointer to location to return user-block size * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pget_userblock() retrieves the size of a user block in a * file creation property list. * * \since 1.0.0 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pget_userblock(hid_t plist_id, hsize_t *size); /** * \ingroup FCPL * * \brief Sets the file space page size for a file creation property list * * \fcpl_id{plist_id} * \param[in] fsp_size File space page size * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pset_file_space_page_size() sets the file space page size * \p fsp_size used in paged aggregation and paged buffering. * * \p fsp_size has a minimum size of 512. Setting a value less * than 512 will return an error. The library default size for * the file space page size when not set is 4096. * * The size set via this routine may not be changed for the life * of the file. * * \since 1.10.1 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pset_file_space_page_size(hid_t plist_id, hsize_t fsp_size); /** * \ingroup FCPL * * \brief Sets the file space handling strategy and persisting free-space * values for a file creation property list * * \fcpl_id{plist_id} * \param[in] strategy The file space handling strategy to be used. See: * #H5F_fspace_strategy_t * \param[in] persist A boolean value to indicate whether free space * should be persistent or not * \param[in] threshold The smallest free-space section size that the free * space manager will track * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pset_file_space_strategy() sets the file space handling * \p strategy, specifies persisting free-space or not (\p persist), * and sets the free-space section size \p threshold in the file * creation property list \p plist_id. * * #H5F_fspace_strategy_t is a struct defined in H5Fpublic.h as * follows: * * \snippet H5Fpublic.h H5F_fspace_strategy_t_snip * * This setting cannot be changed for the life of the file. * * As the #H5F_FSPACE_STRATEGY_AGGR and #H5F_FSPACE_STRATEGY_NONE * strategies do not use the free-space managers, the \p persist * and \p threshold settings will be ignored for those strategies. * * \since 1.10.1 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pset_file_space_strategy(hid_t plist_id, H5F_fspace_strategy_t strategy, hbool_t persist, hsize_t threshold); /** * \ingroup FCPL * * \brief Sets the size of the parameter used to control the B-trees for * indexing chunked datasets * * \fcpl_id{plist_id} * \param[in] ik 1/2 rank of chunked storage B-tree * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pset_istore_k() sets the size of the parameter used to * control the B-trees for indexing chunked datasets. This * function is valid only for file creation property lists. * * \p ik is one half the rank of a tree that stores chunked * raw data. On average, such a tree will be 75% full, or have * an average rank of 1.5 times the value of \p ik. * * The HDF5 library uses (\p ik*2) as the maximum # of entries * before splitting a B-tree node. Since only 2 bytes are used * in storing # of entries for a B-tree node in an HDF5 file, * (\p ik*2) cannot exceed 65536. The default value for * \p ik is 32. * * \version 1.6.4 \p ik parameter type changed to \p unsigned. * \since 1.0.0 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pset_istore_k(hid_t plist_id, unsigned ik); /** * \ingroup FCPL * * \brief Configures the specified shared object header message index * * \fcpl_id{plist_id} * \param[in] index_num Index being configured * \param[in] mesg_type_flags Types of messages that should be stored in * this index * \param[in] min_mesg_size Minimum message size * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pset_shared_mesg_index() is used to configure the specified * shared object header message index, setting the types of * messages that may be stored in the index and the minimum size * of each message. * * \p plist_id specifies the file creation property list. * * \p index_num specifies the index to be configured. * \p index_num is zero-indexed, so in a file with three indexes, * they will be numbered 0, 1, and 2. * * \p mesg_type_flags and \p min_mesg_size specify, respectively, * the types and minimum size of messages that can be stored in * this index. * * Valid message types are as follows: * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * *
#H5O_SHMESG_NONE_FLAGNo shared messages
#H5O_SHMESG_SDSPACE_FLAGSimple dataspace message
#H5O_SHMESG_DTYPE_FLAGDatatype message
#H5O_SHMESG_FILL_FLAGFill value message
#H5O_SHMESG_PLINE_FLAGFilter pipeline message
#H5O_SHMESG_ATTR_FLAGAttribute message
#H5O_SHMESG_ALL_FLAGAll message types; i.e., equivalent to the following: * (#H5O_SHMESG_SDSPACE_FLAG | #H5O_SHMESG_DTYPE_FLAG | * #H5O_SHMESG_FILL_FLAG | #H5O_SHMESG_PLINE_FLAG | * #H5O_SHMESG_ATTR_FLAG)
* * \since 1.8.0 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pset_shared_mesg_index(hid_t plist_id, unsigned index_num, unsigned mesg_type_flags, unsigned min_mesg_size); /** * \ingroup FCPL * * \brief Sets number of shared object header message indexes * * \fcpl_id{plist_id} * \param[in] nindexes Number of shared object header message indexes to be * available in files created with this property list * (\p nindexes must be <= #H5O_SHMESG_MAX_NINDEXES (8)) * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pset_shared_mesg_nindexes() sets the number of shared object * header message indexes in the specified file creation property * list. * * This setting determines the number of shared object header * message indexes, \p nindexes, that will be available in files * created with this property list. These indexes can then be * configured with H5Pset_shared_mesg_index(). * * If \p nindexes is set to 0 (zero), shared object header messages * are disabled in files created with this property list. * * There is a limit of #H5O_SHMESG_MAX_NINDEXES (8) that can be set * with H5Pset_shared_mesg_nindexes(). An error will occur if * specifying a value of \p nindexes that is greater than this value. * * \since 1.8.0 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pset_shared_mesg_nindexes(hid_t plist_id, unsigned nindexes); /** * \ingroup FCPL * * \brief Sets shared object header message storage phase change thresholds * * \fcpl_id{plist_id} * \param[in] max_list Threshold above which storage of a shared object * header message index shifts from list to B-tree * \param[in] min_btree Threshold below which storage of a shared object * header message index reverts to list format * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pset_shared_mesg_phase_change() sets threshold values for * storage of shared object header message indexes in a file. * These phase change thresholds determine the point at which the * index storage mechanism changes from a more compact list format * to a more performance-oriented B-tree format, and vice-versa. * * By default, a shared object header message index is initially * stored as a compact list. When the number of messages in an * index exceeds the threshold value of \p max_list, storage * switches to a B-tree for improved performance. If the number * of messages subsequently falls below the \p min_btree threshold, * the index will revert to the list format. * * If \p max_list is set to 0 (zero), shared object header message * indexes in the file will be created as B-trees and will never * revert to lists. * * \p plist_id specifies the file creation property list. * * \since 1.8.0 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pset_shared_mesg_phase_change(hid_t plist_id, unsigned max_list, unsigned min_btree); /** * \ingroup FCPL * * \brief Sets the byte size of the offsets and lengths used to address * objects in an HDF5 file * * \fcpl_id{plist_id} * \param[in] sizeof_addr Size of an object offset in bytes * \param[in] sizeof_size Size of an object length in bytes * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pset_sizes() sets the byte size of the offsets and lengths * used to address objects in an HDF5 file. This function is only * valid for file creation property lists. Passing in a value * of 0 for one of the parameters retains the current value. The * default value for both values is the same as sizeof(hsize_t) * in the library (normally 8 bytes). Valid values currently * are 2, 4, 8 and 16. * * \since 1.0.0 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pset_sizes(hid_t plist_id, size_t sizeof_addr, size_t sizeof_size); /** * \ingroup FCPL * * \brief * * \fcpl_id{plist_id} * \param[in] ik Symbol table tree rank * \param[in] lk Symbol table node size * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pset_sym_k() sets the size of parameters used to control the * symbol table nodes. * * This function is valid only for file creation property lists. * Passing in a value of zero (0) for one of the parameters retains * the current value. * * \p ik is one half the rank of a B-tree that stores a symbol * table for a group. Internal nodes of the symbol table are on * average 75% full. That is, the average rank of the tree is * 1.5 times the value of \p ik. The HDF5 library uses (\p ik*2) as * the maximum # of entries before splitting a B-tree node. Since * only 2 bytes are used in storing # of entries for a B-tree node * in an HDF5 file, (\p ik*2) cannot exceed 65536. The default value * for \p ik is 16. * * \p lk is one half of the number of symbols that can be stored in * a symbol table node. A symbol table node is the leaf of a symbol * table tree which is used to store a group. When symbols are * inserted randomly into a group, the group's symbol table nodes are * 75% full on average. That is, they contain 1.5 times the number of * symbols specified by \p lk. The default value for \p lk is 4. * * \version 1.6.4 \p ik parameter type changed to \em unsigned. * \version 1.6.0 The \p ik parameter has changed from type int to * \em unsigned. * * \since 1.0.0 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pset_sym_k(hid_t plist_id, unsigned ik, unsigned lk); /** * \ingroup FCPL * * \brief Sets user block size * * \fcpl_id{plist_id} * \param[in] size Size of the user-block in bytes * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pset_userblock() sets the user block size of a file creation * property list. The default user block size is 0; it may be set * to any power of 2 equal to 512 or greater (512, 1024, 2048, etc.). * * \since 1.0.0 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pset_userblock(hid_t plist_id, hsize_t size); /* File access property list (FAPL) routines */ /** * \ingroup FAPL * * \brief Retrieves the current settings for alignment properties from a * file access property list * * \fapl_id * \param[out] threshold Pointer to location of return threshold value * \param[out] alignment Pointer to location of return alignment value * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pget_alignment() retrieves the current settings for * alignment properties from a file access property list. The * \p threshold and/or \p alignment pointers may be null * pointers (NULL). * * \since 1.0.0 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pget_alignment(hid_t fapl_id, hsize_t *threshold /*out*/, hsize_t *alignment /*out*/); /** * \ingroup FAPL * * \brief Queries the raw data chunk cache parameters * * \fapl_id{plist_id} * \param[in,out] mdc_nelmts No longer used * \param[in,out] rdcc_nslots Number of elements (objects) in the raw data * chunk cache * \param[in,out] rdcc_nbytes Total size of the raw data chunk cache, in * bytes * \param[in,out] rdcc_w0 Preemption policy * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pget_cache() retrieves the maximum possible number of * elements in the raw data chunk cache, the maximum possible * number of bytes in the raw data chunk cache, and the * preemption policy value. * * Any (or all) arguments may be null pointers, in which case * the corresponding datum is not returned. * * Note that the \p mdc_nelmts parameter is no longer used. * * \version 1.8.0 Use of the \p mdc_nelmts parameter discontinued. * Metadata cache configuration is managed with * H5Pset_mdc_config() and H5Pget_mdc_config() * \version 1.6.0 The \p rdcc_nbytes and \p rdcc_nslots parameters changed * from type int to size_t. * * \since 1.0.0 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pget_cache(hid_t plist_id, int *mdc_nelmts, /* out */ size_t *rdcc_nslots /*out*/, size_t *rdcc_nbytes /*out*/, double *rdcc_w0); /** * \ingroup FAPL * * \brief Gets information about the write tracking feature used by * the core VFD * * \fapl_id * \param[out] is_enabled Whether the feature is enabled * \param[out] page_size Size, in bytes, of write aggregation pages * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pget_core_write_tracking() retrieves information about the * write tracking feature used by the core VFD. * * When a file is created or opened for writing using the core * virtual file driver (VFD) with the backing store option turned * on, the VFD can be configured to track changes to the file * and only write out the modified bytes. To avoid a large number * of small writes, the changes can be aggregated into pages of * a user-specified size. The core VFD is also known as the * memory VFD. The driver identifier is #H5FD_CORE. * * \note This function is only for use with the core VFD and must be used * after the call to H5Pset_fapl_core(). It is an error to use this * function with any other VFD. * * \note This function only applies to the backing store write operation * which typically occurs when the file is flushed or closed. This * function has no relationship to the increment parameter passed * to H5Pset_fapl_core(). * * \note For optimum performance, the \p page_size parameter should be * a power of two. * * \since 1.8.13 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pget_core_write_tracking(hid_t fapl_id, hbool_t *is_enabled, size_t *page_size); /** * \ingroup FAPL * * \brief Returns low-lever driver identifier * * \plist_id * * \return \hid_t{low level driver} * * \details H5Pget_driver() returns the identifier of the low-level file * driver associated with the file access property list or * data transfer property list \p plist_id. * * Valid driver identifiers distributed with HDF5 are listed and * described in the following table. * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * *
Driver NameDriver IdentifierDescriptionRelated Function
POSIX#H5FD_SEC2This driver uses POSIX file-system functions like read and * write to perform I/O to a single, permanent file on local disk * with no system buffering. This driver is POSIX-compliant and * is the default file driver for all systems.H5Pset_fapl_sec2()
Direct#H5FD_DIRECTThis is the #H5FD_SEC2 driver except data is written to or * read from the file synchronously without being cached by the * system.H5Pset_fapl_direct()
Log#H5FD_LOGThis is the #H5FD_SEC2 driver with logging capabilities.H5Pset_fapl_log()
Windows#H5FD_WINDOWSThis driver was modified in HDF5-1.8.8 to be a wrapper of the * POSIX driver, #H5FD_SEC2. This change should not affect user * applications.H5Pset_fapl_windows()
STDIO#H5FD_STDIOThis driver uses functions from the standard C stdio.h to * perform I/O to a single, permanent file on local disk with * additional system buffering.H5Pset_fapl_stdio()
Memory#H5FD_COREWith this driver, an application can work with a file in * memory for faster reads and writes. File contents are kept in * memory until the file is closed. At closing, the memory * version of the file can be written back to disk or abandoned. * H5Pset_fapl_core()
Family#H5FD_FAMILYWith this driver, the HDF5 file’s address space is partitioned * into pieces and sent to separate storage files using an * underlying driver of the user’s choice. This driver is for * systems that do not support files larger than 2 gigabytes. * H5Pset_fapl_family()
Multi#H5FD_MULTIWith this driver, data can be stored in multiple files * according to the type of the data. I/O might work better if * data is stored in separate files based on the type of data. * The Split driver is a special case of this driver.H5Pset_fapl_multi()
Parallel#H5FD_MPIOThis is the standard HDF5 file driver for parallel file * systems. This driver uses the MPI standard for both * communication and file I/O.H5Pset_fapl_mpio()
Parallel POSIXH5FD_MPIPOSIXThis driver is no longer available.
StreamH5FD_STREAMThis driver is no longer available.
* * This list does not include custom drivers that might be * defined and registered by a user. * * The returned driver identifier is only valid as long as the * file driver remains registered. * * * \since 1.4.0 * */ H5_DLL hid_t H5Pget_driver(hid_t plist_id); /** * \ingroup FAPL * * \brief Returns a pointer to file driver information * * \param[in] plist_id File access or data transfer property list * identifier * * \return Returns a pointer to a struct containing low-level driver * information. Otherwise returns NULL. NULL is also returned if * no driver-specific properties have been registered. No error * is pushed on the stack in this case. * * \details H5Pget_driver_info() returns a pointer to file driver-specific * information for the low-level driver associated with the file * access or data transfer property list \p plist_id. * * The pointer returned by this function points to an “uncopied” * struct. Driver-specific versions of that struct are defined * for each low-level driver in the relevant source code file * H5FD*.c. For example, the struct used for the MULTI driver is * \c H5FD_multi_fapl_t defined in H5FDmulti.c. * * If no driver-specific properties have been registered, * H5Pget_driver_info() returns NULL. * * \note H5Pget_driver_info() and H5Pset_driver() are used only when * creating a virtual file driver (VFD) in the virtual file * layer (VFL). * * \version 1.10.1 Return value was changed from \em void * to * \em const \em void *. * \version 1.8.2 Function publicized in this release; previous releases * described this function only in the virtual file driver * documentation. * */ H5_DLL const void *H5Pget_driver_info(hid_t plist_id); /** * \ingroup FAPL * * \brief Retrieves a string representation of the configuration for * the driver set on the given FAPL. The returned string can * be used to configure the same driver in an identical way. * * \fapl_id * \param[out] config_buf Driver configuration string output buffer * \param[in] buf_size Size of driver configuration string output buffer * * \return Returns the length of the driver configuration string on * success (not including the NUL terminator). Returns negative * on failure. * * \details H5Pget_driver_config_str() retrieves a string representation * of the configuration for the driver set on the given FAPL. The * returned string can be used to configure the same driver in * an identical way. * * If \p config_buf is NULL, the length of the driver configuration * string is simply returned. The caller can then allocate a buffer * of the appropriate size and call this routine again. * * \version 1.12.1 Function publicized in this release. * */ H5_DLL ssize_t H5Pget_driver_config_str(hid_t fapl_id, char *config_buf, size_t buf_size); /** * \ingroup FAPL * * \brief Retrieves the size of the external link open file cache * * \fapl_id{plist_id} * \param[out] efc_size External link open file cache size in number of files * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pget_elink_file_cache_size() retrieves the number of files that * can be held open in an external link open file cache. * * \since 1.8.7 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pget_elink_file_cache_size(hid_t plist_id, unsigned *efc_size); /** * \ingroup FAPL * * \brief Retrieves the file access property list setting that determines * whether an HDF5 object will be evicted from the library's metadata * cache when it is closed * * \fapl_id * \param[out] evict_on_close Pointer to a variable that will indicate if * the object will be evicted on close * * \return \herr_t * * \details The library's metadata cache is fairly conservative about holding on * to HDF5 object metadata (object headers, chunk index structures, * etc.), which can cause the cache size to grow, resulting in memory * pressure on an application or system. When enabled, the "evict on * close" property will cause all metadata for an object to be * immediately evicted from the cache as long as it is not referenced * by any other open object. * * See H5Pset_evict_on_close() for additional notes on behavior. * * \since 1.10.1 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pget_evict_on_close(hid_t fapl_id, hbool_t *evict_on_close); /** * \ingroup FAPL * * \brief Retrieves a data offset from the file access property list * * \fapl_id * \param[out] offset Offset in bytes within the HDF5 file * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pget_family_offset() retrieves the value of offset from the * file access property list \p fapl_id so that the user * application can retrieve a file handle for low-level access to * a particular member of a family of files. The file handle is * retrieved with a separate call to H5Fget_vfd_handle() (or, * in special circumstances, to H5FDget_vfd_handle(), see \ref VFL). * * \since 1.6.0 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pget_family_offset(hid_t fapl_id, hsize_t *offset); /** * \ingroup FAPL * * \brief Returns the file close degree * * \fapl_id * \param[out] degree Pointer to a location to which to return the file * close degree property, the value of \p degree * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pget_fclose_degree() returns the current setting of the file * close degree property \p degree in the file access property * list \p fapl_id. The value of \p degree determines how * aggressively H5Fclose() deals with objects within a file that * remain open when H5Fclose() is called to close that file. * * \since 1.6.0 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pget_fclose_degree(hid_t fapl_id, H5F_close_degree_t *degree); /** * \ingroup FAPL * * \brief Retrieves a copy of the file image designated as the initial content * and structure of a file * * \fapl_id * \param[in,out] buf_ptr_ptr On input, \c NULL or a pointer to a * pointer to a buffer that contains the * file image.\n On successful return, if \p buf_ptr_ptr is not * \c NULL, \Code{*buf_ptr_ptr} will contain a pointer to a copy * of the initial image provided in the last call to * H5Pset_file_image() for the supplied \p fapl_id. If no initial * image has been set, \Code{*buf_ptr_ptr} will be \c NULL. * \param[in,out] buf_len_ptr On input, \c NULL or a pointer to a buffer * specifying the required size of the buffer to hold the file * image.\n On successful return, if \p buf_len_ptr was not * passed in as \c NULL, \p buf_len_ptr will return the required * size in bytes of the buffer to hold the initial file image in * the supplied file access property list, \p fapl_id. If no * initial image is set, the value of \Code{*buf_len_ptr} will be * set to 0 (zero) * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pget_file_image() allows an application to retrieve a copy of the * file image designated for a VFD to use as the initial contents of a file. * * If file image callbacks are defined, H5Pget_file_image() will use * them when allocating and loading the buffer to return to the * application (see H5Pset_file_image_callbacks()). If file image * callbacks are not defined, the function will use \c malloc and \c * memcpy. When \c malloc and \c memcpy are used, it is the caller’s * responsibility to discard the returned buffer with a call to \c * free. * * It is the responsibility of the calling application to free the * buffer whose address is returned in \p buf_ptr_ptr. This can be * accomplished with \c free if file image callbacks have not been set * (see H5Pset_file_image_callbacks()) or with the appropriate method * if file image callbacks have been set. * * \see H5LTopen_file_image(), H5Fget_file_image(), H5Pset_file_image(), * H5Pset_file_image_callbacks(), H5Pget_file_image_callbacks(), * \ref H5FD_file_image_callbacks_t, \ref H5FD_file_image_op_t, * * HDF5 File Image Operations. * * * \since 1.8.9 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pget_file_image(hid_t fapl_id, void **buf_ptr_ptr, size_t *buf_len_ptr); /** * \ingroup FAPL * * \brief Retrieves callback routines for working with file images * * \fapl_id * \param[in,out] callbacks_ptr Pointer to the instance of the * #H5FD_file_image_callbacks_t struct in which the callback * routines are to be returned\n * Struct fields must be initialized to NULL before the call * is made.\n * Struct field contents upon return will match those passed in * in the last H5Pset_file_image_callbacks() call for the file * access property list \p fapl_id. * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pget_file_image_callbacks() retrieves the callback routines set for * working with file images opened with the file access property list * \p fapl_id. * * The callbacks must have been previously set with * H5Pset_file_image_callbacks() in the file access property list. * * Upon the successful return of H5Pset_file_image_callbacks(), the * fields in the instance of the #H5FD_file_image_callbacks_t struct * pointed to by \p callbacks_ptr will contain the same values as were * passed in the most recent H5Pset_file_image_callbacks() call for the * file access property list \p fapl_id. * * \see H5LTopen_file_image(), H5Fget_file_image(), H5Pset_file_image(), * H5Pset_file_image_callbacks(), H5Pget_file_image_callbacks(), * \ref H5FD_file_image_callbacks_t, \ref H5FD_file_image_op_t, * * HDF5 File Image Operations. * * \since 1.8.9 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pget_file_image_callbacks(hid_t fapl_id, H5FD_file_image_callbacks_t *callbacks_ptr); /** * \ingroup FAPL * * \brief Retrieves the file locking property values * * \fapl_id * \param[out] use_file_locking File locking flag * \param[out] ignore_when_disabled Ignore when disabled flag * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pget_file_locking() retrieves the file locking property values for * the file access property list specified by \p fapl_id. * * \since 1.10.7 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pget_file_locking(hid_t fapl_id, hbool_t *use_file_locking, hbool_t *ignore_when_disabled); /** * \ingroup FAPL * * \brief Returns garbage collecting references setting * * \fapl_id * \param[out] gc_ref Flag returning the state of reference garbage * collection. A returned value of 1 indicates that * garbage collection is on while 0 indicates that * garbage collection is off. * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pget_gc_references() returns the current setting for the * garbage collection references property from the specified * file access property list. The garbage collection references * property is set by H5Pset_gc_references(). * * \since 1.2.0 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pget_gc_references(hid_t fapl_id, unsigned *gc_ref /*out*/); /** * \ingroup FAPL * * \brief Retrieves library version bounds settings that indirectly control * the format versions used when creating objects * * \fapl_id{plist_id} * \param[out] low The earliest version of the library that will be used * for writing objects * \param[out] high The latest version of the library that will be used for * writing objects * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pget_libver_bounds() retrieves the lower and upper bounds on * the HDF5 library release versions that indirectly determine the * object format versions used when creating objects in the file. * * This property is retrieved from the file access property list * specified by the parameter \p fapl_id. * * The value returned in the parameters \p low and \p high is one * of the enumerated values in the #H5F_libver_t struct, which is * defined in H5Fpublic.h. * * \version 1.10.2 Add #H5F_LIBVER_V18 to the enumerated defines in * #H5F_libver_t * \since 1.8.0 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pget_libver_bounds(hid_t plist_id, H5F_libver_t *low, H5F_libver_t *high); /** * \ingroup FAPL * * \brief Get the current initial metadata cache configuration from the * provided file access property list * * \fapl_id{plist_id} * \param[in,out] config_ptr Pointer to the instance of #H5AC_cache_config_t * in which the current metadata cache configuration is to be * reported * \return \herr_t * * \note The \c in direction applies only to the \ref H5AC_cache_config_t.version * field. All other fields are \c out parameters. * * \details The fields of the #H5AC_cache_config_t structure are shown * below: * \snippet H5ACpublic.h H5AC_cache_config_t_snip * \click4more * * H5Pget_mdc_config() gets the initial metadata cache configuration * contained in a file access property list and loads it into the * instance of #H5AC_cache_config_t pointed to by the \p config_ptr * parameter. This configuration is used when the file is opened. * * Note that the version field of \Code{*config_ptr} must be * initialized; this allows the library to support earlier versions of * the #H5AC_cache_config_t structure. * * See the overview of the metadata cache in the special topics section * of the user guide for details on the configuration data returned. If * you haven't read and understood that documentation, the results of * this call will not make much sense. * * \since 1.8.0 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pget_mdc_config(hid_t plist_id, H5AC_cache_config_t *config_ptr); /* out */ /** * \ingroup FAPL * * \brief Retrieves the metadata cache image configuration values for a file * access property list * * \fapl_id{plist_id} * \param[out] config_ptr Pointer to metadata cache image configuration values * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pget_mdc_image_config() retrieves the metadata cache image values * into \p config_ptr for the file access property list specified in \p * plist_id. * * #H5AC_cache_image_config_t is defined as follows: * \snippet H5ACpublic.h H5AC_cache_image_config_t_snip * \click4more * * \since 1.10.1 */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pget_mdc_image_config(hid_t plist_id, H5AC_cache_image_config_t *config_ptr /*out*/); /** * \ingroup FAPL * * \brief Gets metadata cache logging options * * \fapl_id{plist_id} * \param[out] is_enabled Flag whether logging is enabled * \param[out] location Location of log in UTF-8/ASCII (file path/name) (On * Windows, this must be ASCII) * \param[out] location_size Size in bytes of the location string * \param[out] start_on_access Whether the logging begins as soon as the file is * opened or created * \return \herr_t * * \details The metadata cache is a central part of the HDF5 library through * which all file metadata reads and writes take place. File metadata * is normally invisible to the user and is used by the library for * purposes such as locating and indexing data. File metadata should * not be confused with user metadata, which consists of attributes * created by users and attached to HDF5 objects such as datasets via * \ref H5A API calls. * * Due to the complexity of the cache, a trace/logging feature has been * created that can be used by HDF5 developers for debugging and * performance analysis. The functions that control this functionality * will normally be of use to a very limited number of developers * outside of The HDF Group. The functions have been documented to help * users create logs that can be sent with bug reports. * * Control of the log functionality is straightforward. Logging is * enabled via the H5Pset_mdc_log_options() function, which will modify * the file access property list used to open or create a file. This * function has a flag that determines whether logging begins at file * open or starts in a paused state. Log messages can then be * controlled via the H5Fstart_mdc_logging() / H5Fstop_mdc_logging() * functions. H5Pget_mdc_log_options() can be used to examine a file * access property list, and H5Fget_mdc_logging_status() will return * the current state of the logging flags. * * The log format is described in the * Metadata Cache Logging document. * * \since 1.10.0 */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pget_mdc_log_options(hid_t plist_id, hbool_t *is_enabled, char *location, size_t *location_size, hbool_t *start_on_access); /** * \ingroup FAPL * * \brief Returns the current metadata block size setting * * \fapl_id{fapl_id} * \param[out] size Minimum size, in bytes, of metadata block allocations * * \return \herr_t * * \details Returns the current minimum size, in bytes, of new * metadata block allocations. This setting is retrieved from the * file access property list \p fapl_id. * * This value is set by H5Pset_meta_block_size() and is * retrieved from the file access property list \p fapl_id. * * \since 1.4.0 */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pget_meta_block_size(hid_t fapl_id, hsize_t *size); /** * \ingroup FAPL * * \brief Retrieves the number of read attempts from a file access * property list * * \fapl_id{plist_id} * \param[out] attempts The number of read attempts * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pget_metadata_read_attempts() retrieves the number of read * attempts that is set in the file access property list \p plist_id. * * For a default file access property list, the value retrieved * will depend on whether the user sets the number of attempts via * H5Pset_metadata_read_attempts(): * * * * For the file access property list of a specified HDF5 file, * the value retrieved will depend on how the file is opened * and whether the user sets the number of read attempts via * H5Pset_metadata_read_attempts(): * * * * \par Failure Modes * \parblock * * When the input property list is not a file access property list. * * When the library is unable to retrieve the number of read attempts from * the file access property list. * * \endparblock * * \par Examples * \parblock * * The first example illustrates the two cases for retrieving the number * of read attempts from a default file access property list. * * \include H5Pget_metadata_read_attempts.1.c * * The second example illustrates the two cases for retrieving the * number of read attempts from the file access property list of a file * opened with SWMR access. * * \include H5Pget_metadata_read_attempts.2.c * * The third example illustrates the two cases for retrieving the number * of read attempts from the file access property list of a file opened * with non-SWMR access. * * \include H5Pget_metadata_read_attempts.3.c * * \endparblock * * \since 1.10.0 */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pget_metadata_read_attempts(hid_t plist_id, unsigned *attempts); /** * \ingroup FAPL * * \brief Retrieves type of data property for MULTI driver * * \param[in] fapl_id File access property list or data transfer property * list identifier * \param[out] type Type of data * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pget_multi_type() retrieves the type of data setting from * the file access or data transfer property list \p fapl_id. * This enables a user application to specify the type of data * the application wishes to access so that the application can * retrieve a file handle for low-level access to the particular * member of a set of MULTI files in which that type of data is * stored. The file handle is retrieved with a separate call to * H5Fget_vfd_handle() (or, in special circumstances, to * H5FDget_vfd_handle(); see the Virtual File Layer documentation * for more information. * * The type of data returned in \p type will be one of those * listed in the discussion of the \p type parameter in the the * description of the function H5Pset_multi_type(). * * Use of this function is only appropriate for an HDF5 file * written as a set of files with the MULTI file driver. * * \since 1.6.0 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pget_multi_type(hid_t fapl_id, H5FD_mem_t *type); /** * \ingroup FAPL * * \brief Retrieves the object flush property values from the file access property list * * \fapl_id{plist_id} * \param[in] func The user-defined callback function * \param[in] udata The user-defined input data for the callback function * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pget_object_flush_cb() gets the user-defined callback * function that is set in the file access property list * \p fapl_id and stored in the parameter \p func. The callback is * invoked whenever an object flush occurs in the file. This * routine also obtains the user-defined input data that is * passed along to the callback function in the parameter * \p udata. * * \par Example * \parblock * The example below illustrates the usage of this routine to obtain the * object flush property values. * * \include H5Pget_object_flush_cb.c * \endparblock * * \since 1.10.0 */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pget_object_flush_cb(hid_t plist_id, H5F_flush_cb_t *func, void **udata); /** * \ingroup FAPL * * \brief Retrieves the maximum size for the page buffer and the minimum percentage for metadata and raw data pages * * \fapl_id{plist_id} * \param[out] buf_size Maximum size, in bytes, of the page buffer * \param[out] min_meta_perc Minimum metadata percentage to keep in the * page buffer before allowing pages containing metadata to * be evicted * * \param[out] min_raw_perc Minimum raw data percentage to keep in the * page buffer before allowing pages containing raw data to * be evicted * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pget_page_buffer_size() retrieves \p buf_size, the maximum * size in bytes of the page buffer, \p min_meta_perc, the * minimum metadata percentage, and \p min_raw_perc, the * minimum raw data percentage. * * \since 1.10.1 */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pget_page_buffer_size(hid_t plist_id, size_t *buf_size, unsigned *min_meta_perc, unsigned *min_raw_perc); /** * \ingroup FAPL * * \brief Returns maximum data sieve buffer size * * \fapl_id{fapl_id} * \param[in] size Maximum size, in bytes, of data sieve buffer * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pget_sieve_buf_size() retrieves, size, the current maximum * size of the data sieve buffer. * * This value is set by H5Pset_sieve_buf_size() and is retrieved * from the file access property list fapl_id. * * \version 1.6.0 The \p size parameter has changed from type \c hsize_t * to \c size_t * \since 1.4.0 */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pget_sieve_buf_size(hid_t fapl_id, size_t *size /*out*/); /** * \ingroup FAPL * * \brief Retrieves the current small data block size setting * * \fapl_id{fapl_id} * \param[out] size Maximum size, in bytes, of the small data block * * \result \herr_t * * \details H5Pget_small_data_block_size() retrieves the current setting * for the size of the small data block. * * If the returned value is zero (0), the small data block * mechanism has been disabled for the file. * * \since 1.4.4 */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pget_small_data_block_size(hid_t fapl_id, hsize_t *size /*out*/); /** * \ingroup FAPL * * \brief Returns the identifier of the current VOL connector * * \fapl_id{plist_id} * \param[out] vol_id Current VOL connector identifier * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pget_vol_id() returns the VOL connector identifier \p vol_id for * the file access property list \p plist_id. This identifier should * be closed with H5VLclose(). * * \since 1.12.0 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pget_vol_id(hid_t plist_id, hid_t *vol_id); /** * \ingroup FAPL * * \brief Returns a copy of the VOL information for a connector * * \fapl_id{plist_id} * \param[out] vol_info The VOL information for a connector * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pget_vol_info() returns a copy of the VOL information \p vol_info * for a connector specified by the file access property list * \p plist_id. * * \since 1.12.0 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pget_vol_info(hid_t plist_id, void **vol_info); /** * \ingroup FAPL * * \brief Sets alignment properties of a file access property list * * \fapl_id * \param[in] threshold Threshold value. Note that setting the threshold * value to 0 (zero) has the effect of a special case, * forcing everything to be aligned * \param[in] alignment Alignment value * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pset_alignment() sets the alignment properties of a * file access property list so that any file object greater * than or equal in size to \p threshold bytes will be aligned * on an address which is a multiple of \p alignment. The * addresses are relative to the end of the user block; the * alignment is calculated by subtracting the user block size * from the absolute file address and then adjusting the address * to be a multiple of \p alignment. * * Default values for \p threshold and \p alignment are one, * implying no alignment. Generally the default values will * result in the best performance for single-process access to * the file. For MPI IO and other parallel systems, choose an * alignment which is a multiple of the disk block size. * * If the file space handling strategy is set to * #H5F_FSPACE_STRATEGY_PAGE, then the alignment set via this * routine is ignored. The file space handling strategy is set * by H5Pset_file_space_strategy(). * * \since 1.0.0 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pset_alignment(hid_t fapl_id, hsize_t threshold, hsize_t alignment); /** * \ingroup FAPL * * \brief Sets the raw data chunk cache parameters * * \fapl_id{plist_id} * \param[in] mdc_nelmts No longer used; any value passed is ignored * \param[in] rdcc_nslots The number of chunk slots in the raw data chunk * cache for this dataset. Increasing this value * reduces the number of cache collisions, but * slightly increases the memory used. Due to the * hashing strategy, this value should ideally be a * prime number. As a rule of thumb, this value * should be at least 10 times the number of chunks * that can fit in \p rdcc_nbytes bytes. For * maximum performance, this value should be set * approximately 100 times that number of chunks. * The default value is 521. * \param[in] rdcc_nbytes Total size of the raw data chunk cache in bytes. * The default size is 1 MB per dataset. * \param[in] rdcc_w0 The chunk preemption policy for all datasets. * This must be between 0 and 1 inclusive and * indicates the weighting according to which chunks * which have been fully read or written are * penalized when determining which chunks to flush * from cache. A value of 0 means fully read or * written chunks are treated no differently than * other chunks (the preemption is strictly LRU) * while a value of 1 means fully read or written * chunks are always preempted before other chunks. * If your application only reads or writes data once, * this can be safely set to 1. Otherwise, this should * be set lower depending on how often you re-read or * re-write the same data. The default value is 0.75. * If the value passed is #H5D_CHUNK_CACHE_W0_DEFAULT, * then the property will not be set on the dataset * access property list, and the parameter will come * from the file access property list. * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pset_cache() sets the number of elements, the total number of * bytes, and the preemption policy value for all datasets in a file * on the file’s file access property list. * * The raw data chunk cache inserts chunks into the cache by first * computing a hash value using the address of a chunk and then by * using that hash value as the chunk’s index into the table of * cached chunks. In other words, the size of this hash table and the * number of possible hash values is determined by the \p rdcc_nslots * parameter. If a different chunk in the cache has the same hash value, * a collision will occur, which will reduce efficiency. If inserting * the chunk into the cache would cause the cache to be too big, then * the cache will be pruned according to the \p rdcc_w0 parameter. * * The \p mdc_nelmts parameter is no longer used; any value passed * in that parameter will be ignored. * * \b Motivation: Setting raw data chunk cache parameters * can be done with H5Pset_cache(), H5Pset_chunk_cache(), * or a combination of both. H5Pset_cache() is used to * adjust the chunk cache parameters for all datasets via * a global setting for the file, and H5Pset_chunk_cache() * is used to adjust the chunk cache parameters for * individual datasets. When both are used, parameters * set with H5Pset_chunk_cache() will override any parameters * set with H5Pset_cache(). * * \note Optimum chunk cache parameters may vary widely depending * on different data layout and access patterns. For datasets * with low performance requirements for example, changing * the cache settings can save memory. * * \note Note: Raw dataset chunk caching is not currently * supported when using the MPI I/O and MPI POSIX file drivers * in read/write mode; see H5Pset_fapl_mpio(). When using this * file driver, all calls to H5Dread() and H5Dwrite() will access * the disk directly, and H5Pset_cache() will have no effect on * performance. * * \note Raw dataset chunk caching is supported when these drivers are * used in read-only mode. * * \version 1.8.0 The use of the \p mdc_nelmts parameter was discontinued. * Metadata cache configuration is managed with * H5Pset_mdc_config() and H5Pget_mdc_config(). * \version 1.6.0 The \p rdcc_nbytes and \p rdcc_nelmts parameters * changed from type int to size_t. * \since 1.0.0 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pset_cache(hid_t plist_id, int mdc_nelmts, size_t rdcc_nslots, size_t rdcc_nbytes, double rdcc_w0); /** * \ingroup FAPL * * \brief Sets write tracking information for core driver, #H5FD_CORE * * \fapl_id{fapl_id} * \param[in] is_enabled Boolean value specifying whether feature is enabled * \param[in] page_size Positive integer specifying size, in bytes, of * write aggregation pages Value of 1 (one) enables * tracking with no paging. * * \return \herr_t * * \details When a file is created or opened for writing using the core * virtual file driver (VFD) with the backing store option * turned on, the core driver can be configured to track * changes to the file and write out only the modified bytes. * * This write tracking feature is enabled and disabled with \p * is_enabled. The default setting is that write tracking is * disabled, or off. * * To avoid a large number of small writes, changes can * be aggregated into pages of a user-specified size, \p * page_size. * * Setting \p page_size to 1 enables tracking with no page * aggregation. * * The backing store option is set via the function * H5Pset_fapl_core. * * \attention * \parblock * This function is only for use with the core VFD and must * be used after the call to H5Pset_fapl_core(). It is an error * to use this function with any other VFD. * * It is an error to use this function when the backing store * flag has not been set using H5Pset_fapl_core(). * * This function only applies to the backing store write * operation which typically occurs when the file is flushed * or closed. This function has no relationship to the * increment parameter passed to H5Pset_fapl_core(). * * For optimum performance, the \p page_size parameter should be * a power of two. * * It is an error to set the page size to 0. * \endparblock * * \version 1.8.14 C function modified in this release to return error * if \p page_size is set to 0 (zero). * \since 1.8.13 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pset_core_write_tracking(hid_t fapl_id, hbool_t is_enabled, size_t page_size); /** * \ingroup FAPL * * \brief Sets a file driver * * \plist_id * \param[in] driver_id The new driver identifier * \param[in] driver_info Optional struct containing driver properties * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pset_driver() sets the file driver, driver_id, for a file * access or data transfer property list, \p plist_id, and * supplies an optional struct containing the driver-specific * properties, \p driver_info. * * The driver properties will be copied into the property list * and the reference count on the driver will be incremented, * allowing the caller to close the driver identifier but still * use the property list. * * \version 1.8.2 Function publicized in this release; previous releases * described this function only in the virtual file driver * documentation. * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pset_driver(hid_t plist_id, hid_t driver_id, const void *driver_info); /** * \ingroup FAPL * * \brief Sets a file driver according to a given driver name * * \plist_id * \param[in] driver_name The new driver name * \param[in] driver_config Optional string containing driver properties * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pset_driver_by_name() sets the file driver, by the name * driver_name, for a file access or data transfer property list, * \p plist_id, and supplies an optional string containing the * driver-specific properties, \p driver_config. The driver * properties string will be copied into the property list. * * If the driver specified by \p driver_name is not currently * registered, an attempt will be made to load the driver as a * plugin. * * \version 1.12.1 Function publicized in this release. * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pset_driver_by_name(hid_t plist_id, const char *driver_name, const char *driver_config); /** * \ingroup FAPL * * \brief Sets a file driver according to a given driver value (ID). * * \plist_id * \param[in] driver_value The new driver value (ID) * \param[in] driver_config Optional string containing driver properties * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pset_driver_by_value() sets the file driver, by the value * driver_value, for a file access or data transfer property list, * \p plist_id, and supplies an optional string containing the * driver-specific properties, \p driver_config. The driver * properties string will be copied into the property list. * * If the driver specified by \p driver_value is not currently * registered, an attempt will be made to load the driver as a * plugin. * * \version 1.12.1 Function publicized in this release. * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pset_driver_by_value(hid_t plist_id, H5FD_class_value_t driver_value, const char *driver_config); /** * \ingroup FAPL * * \brief Sets the number of files that can be held open in an external * link open file cache * * \par Motivation * \parblock * The external link open file cache holds files open after * they have been accessed via an external link. This cache reduces * the number of times such files are opened when external links are * accessed repeatedly and can significantly improves performance in * certain heavy-use situations and when low-level file opens or closes * are expensive. * * H5Pset_elink_file_cache_size() sets the number of files * that will be held open in an external link open file * cache. H5Pget_elink_file_cache_size() retrieves the size of an existing * cache; and H5Fclear_elink_file_cache() clears an existing cache without * closing it. * \endparblock * * \fapl_id{plist_id} * \param[in] efc_size External link open file cache size in number of files * Default setting is 0 (zero). * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pset_elink_file_cache_size() specifies the number of files * that will be held open in an external link open file cache. * * The default external link open file cache size is 0 (zero), * meaning that files accessed via an external link are not * held open. Setting the cache size to a positive integer * turns on the cache; setting the size back to zero turns it * off. * * With this property set, files are placed in the external * link open file cache cache when they are opened via an * external link. Files are then held open until either * they are evicted from the cache or the parent file is * closed. This property setting can improve performance when * external links are repeatedly accessed. * * When the cache is full, files will be evicted using a least * recently used (LRU) scheme; the file which has gone the * longest time without being accessed through the parent file * will be evicted and closed if nothing else is holding that * file open. * * Files opened through external links inherit the parent * file’s file access property list by default, and therefore * inherit the parent file’s external link open file cache * setting. * * When child files contain external links of their own, the * caches can form a graph of cached external files. Closing * the last external reference to such a graph will recursively * close all files in the graph, even if cycles are present. * \par Example * \parblock * The following code sets up an external link open file cache that will * hold open up to 8 files reached through external links: * * \code * status = H5Pset_elink_file_cache_size(fapl_id, 8); * \endcode * \endparblock * * \since 1.8.7 */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pset_elink_file_cache_size(hid_t plist_id, unsigned efc_size); /** * \ingroup FAPL * * \brief Controls the library's behavior of evicting metadata associated with * a closed object * * \fapl_id * \param[in] evict_on_close Whether the HDF5 object should be evicted on close * * \return \herr_t * * \details The library's metadata cache is fairly conservative about holding * on to HDF5 object metadata(object headers, chunk index structures, * etc.), which can cause the cache size to grow, resulting in memory * pressure on an application or system. When enabled, the "evict on * close" property will cause all metadata for an object to be evicted * from the cache as long as metadata is not referenced by any other * open object. * * This function only applies to file access property lists. * * The default library behavior is to not evict on object or file * close. * * When applied to a file access property list, any subsequently opened * object will inherit the "evict on close" property and will have * its metadata evicted when the object is closed. * * \since 1.10.1 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pset_evict_on_close(hid_t fapl_id, hbool_t evict_on_close); /** * \ingroup FAPL * * \brief Sets offset property for low-level access to a file in a family of * files * * \fapl_id * \param[in] offset Offset in bytes within the HDF5 file * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pset_family_offset() sets the offset property in the file access * property list \p fapl_id so that the user application can * retrieve a file handle for low-level access to a particular member * of a family of files. The file handle is retrieved with a separate * call to H5Fget_vfd_handle() (or, in special circumstances, to * H5FDget_vfd_handle(); see \ref VFL). * * The value of \p offset is an offset in bytes from the beginning of * the HDF5 file, identifying a user-determined location within the * HDF5 file. * The file handle the user application is seeking is for the specific * member-file in the associated family of files to which this offset * is mapped. * * Use of this function is only appropriate for an HDF5 file written as * a family of files with the \c FAMILY file driver. * * \since 1.6.0 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pset_family_offset(hid_t fapl_id, hsize_t offset); /** * \ingroup FAPL * * \brief Sets the file close degree * * \fapl_id * \param[in] degree Pointer to a location containing the file close * degree property, the value of \p degree * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pset_fclose_degree() sets the file close degree property * \p degree in the file access property list \p fapl_id. * * The value of \p degree determines how aggressively * H5Fclose() deals with objects within a file that remain open * when H5Fclose() is called to close that file. \p degree can * have any one of four valid values: * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * *
Degree nameH5Fclose behavior with no open object in fileH5Fclose behavior with open object(s) in file
#H5F_CLOSE_WEAKActual file is closed.Access to file identifier is terminated; actual file * close is delayed until all objects in file are closed *
#H5F_CLOSE_SEMIActual file is closed.Function returns FAILURE
#H5F_CLOSE_STRONGActual file is closed.All open objects remaining in the file are closed then * file is closed
#H5F_CLOSE_DEFAULTThe VFL driver chooses the behavior. Currently, all VFL * drivers set this value to #H5F_CLOSE_WEAK, except for the * MPI-I/O driver, which sets it to #H5F_CLOSE_SEMI.
* \warning If a file is opened multiple times without being closed, each * open operation must use the same file close degree setting. * For example, if a file is already open with #H5F_CLOSE_WEAK, * an H5Fopen() call with #H5F_CLOSE_STRONG will fail. * * \since 1.6.0 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pset_fclose_degree(hid_t fapl_id, H5F_close_degree_t degree); /** * \ingroup FAPL * * \brief Sets an initial file image in a memory buffer * * \fapl_id * \param[in] buf_ptr Pointer to the initial file image, or * NULL if no initial file image is desired * \param[in] buf_len Size of the supplied buffer, or * 0 (zero) if no initial image is desired * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pset_file_image() allows an application to provide a file image * to be used as the initial contents of a file. * Calling H5Pset_file_image()makes a copy of the buffer specified in * \p buf_ptr of size \p buf_len. * * \par Motivation: * H5Pset_file_image() and other elements of HDF5 are * used to load an image of an HDF5 file into system memory and open * that image as a regular HDF5 file. An application can then use the * file without the overhead of disk I/O. * * \par Recommended Reading: * This function is part of the file image * operations feature set. It is highly recommended to study the guide * [HDF5 File Image Operations] * (https://portal.hdfgroup.org/display/HDF5/HDF5+File+Image+Operations * ) before using this feature set. See the “See Also” section below * for links to other elements of HDF5 file image operations. * * \see * \li H5LTopen_file_image() * \li H5Fget_file_image() * \li H5Pget_file_image() * \li H5Pset_file_image_callbacks() * \li H5Pget_file_image_callbacks() * * \li [HDF5 File Image Operations] * (https://portal.hdfgroup.org/display/HDF5/HDF5+File+Image+Operations) * in [Advanced Topics in HDF5] * (https://portal.hdfgroup.org/display/HDF5/Advanced+Topics+in+HDF5) * * \li Within H5Pset_file_image_callbacks(): * \li Callback #H5FD_file_image_callbacks_t * \li Callback #H5FD_file_image_op_t * * \version 1.8.13 Fortran subroutine added in this release. * \since 1.8.9 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pset_file_image(hid_t fapl_id, void *buf_ptr, size_t buf_len); /** * \ingroup FAPL * * \brief Sets the callbacks for working with file images * * \note **Motivation:** H5Pset_file_image_callbacks() and other elements * of HDF5 are used to load an image of an HDF5 file into system * memory and open that image as a regular HDF5 file. An application * can then use the file without the overhead of disk I/O.\n * **Recommended Reading:** This function is part of the file * image operations feature set. It is highly recommended to study * the guide [HDF5 File Image Operations] * (https://portal.hdfgroup.org/display/HDF5/HDF5+File+Image+Operations * ) before using this feature set. See the “See Also” section below * for links to other elements of HDF5 file image operations. * * \fapl_id * \param[in,out] callbacks_ptr Pointer to the instance of the * #H5FD_file_image_callbacks_t structure * * \return \herr_t \n * **Failure Modes**: Due to interactions between this function and * H5Pset_file_image() and H5Pget_file_image(), * H5Pset_file_image_callbacks() will fail if a file image has * already been set in the target file access property list, \p fapl_id. * * \details H5Pset_file_image_callbacks() sets callback functions for working * with file images in memory. * * H5Pset_file_image_callbacks() allows an application to control the * management of file image buffers through user defined callbacks. * These callbacks can be used in the management of file image buffers * in property lists and with certain file drivers. * * H5Pset_file_image_callbacks() must be used before any file image has * been set in the file access property list. Once a file image has * been set, the function will fail. * * The callback routines set up by H5Pset_file_image_callbacks() are * invoked when a new file image buffer is allocated, when an existing * file image buffer is copied or resized, or when a file image buffer * is released from use. * * Some file drivers allow the use of user-defined callback functions * for allocating, freeing, and copying the driver’s internal buffer, * potentially allowing optimizations such as avoiding large \c malloc * and \c memcpy operations, or to perform detailed logging. * * From the perspective of the HDF5 library, the operations of the * \ref H5FD_file_image_callbacks_t.image_malloc "image_malloc", * \ref H5FD_file_image_callbacks_t.image_memcpy "image_memcpy", * \ref H5FD_file_image_callbacks_t.image_realloc "image_realloc", and * \ref H5FD_file_image_callbacks_t.image_free "image_free" callbacks * must be identical to those of the * corresponding C standard library calls (\c malloc, \c memcpy, * \c realloc, and \c free). While the operations must be identical, * the file image callbacks have more parameters. The return values * of \ref H5FD_file_image_callbacks_t.image_malloc "image_malloc" and * \ref H5FD_file_image_callbacks_t.image_realloc "image_realloc" are identical to * the return values of \c malloc and \c realloc. The return values of * \ref H5FD_file_image_callbacks_t.image_malloc "image_malloc" and * \ref H5FD_file_image_callbacks_t.image_free "image_free" differ from the return * values of \c memcpy and \c free in that the return values of * \ref H5FD_file_image_callbacks_t.image_memcpy "image_memcpy" and * \ref H5FD_file_image_callbacks_t.image_free "image_free" can also indicate failure. * * The callbacks and their parameters, along with a struct and * an \c ENUM required for their use, are described below. * * Callback struct and \c ENUM: * * The callback functions set up by H5Pset_file_image_callbacks() use * a struct and an \c ENUM that are defined as follows * * The struct #H5FD_file_image_callbacks_t serves as a container * for the callback functions and a pointer to user-supplied data. * The struct is defined as follows: * \snippet H5FDpublic.h H5FD_file_image_callbacks_t_snip * * Elements of the #H5FD_file_image_op_t are used by the * callbacks to invoke certain operations on file images. The ENUM is * defined as follows: * \snippet H5FDpublic.h H5FD_file_image_op_t_snip * * The elements of the #H5FD_file_image_op_t are used in the following * callbacks: * * - The \ref H5FD_file_image_callbacks_t.image_malloc "image_malloc" callback * contains a pointer to a function that must appear to HDF5 to have * functionality identical to that of the standard C library \c malloc() call. * * - Signature in #H5FD_file_image_callbacks_t: * \snippet H5FDpublic.h image_malloc_snip * \n * - The \ref H5FD_file_image_callbacks_t.image_memcpy "image_memcpy" * callback contains a pointer to a function * that must appear to HDF5 to have functionality identical to that * of the standard C library \c memcopy() call, except that it returns * a \p NULL on failure. (The \c memcpy C Library routine is defined * to return the \p dest parameter in all cases.) * * - Setting \ref H5FD_file_image_callbacks_t.image_memcpy "image_memcpy" * to \c NULL indicates that HDF5 should invoke * the standard C library \c memcpy() routine when copying buffers. * * - Signature in #H5FD_file_image_callbacks_t: * \snippet H5FDpublic.h image_memcpy_snip * \n * - The \ref H5FD_file_image_callbacks_t.image_realloc "image_realloc" callback * contains a pointer to a function that must appear to HDF5 to have * functionality identical to that of the standard C library \c realloc() call. * * - Setting \ref H5FD_file_image_callbacks_t.image_realloc "image_realloc" * to \p NULL indicates that HDF5 should * invoke the standard C library \c realloc() routine when resizing * file image buffers. * * - Signature in #H5FD_file_image_callbacks_t: * \snippet H5FDpublic.h image_realloc_snip * \n * - The \ref H5FD_file_image_callbacks_t.image_free "image_free" callback contains * a pointer to a function that must appear to HDF5 to have functionality * identical to that of the standard C library \c free() call, except * that it will return \c 0 (\c SUCCEED) on success and \c -1 (\c FAIL) on failure. * * - Setting \ref H5FD_file_image_callbacks_t.image_free "image_free" * to \c NULL indicates that HDF5 should invoke * the standard C library \c free() routine when releasing file image * buffers. * * - Signature in #H5FD_file_image_callbacks_t: * \snippet H5FDpublic.h image_free_snip * \n * - The \ref H5FD_file_image_callbacks_t.udata_copy "udata_copy" * callback contains a pointer to a function * that, from the perspective of HDF5, allocates a buffer of suitable * size, copies the contents of the supplied \p udata into the new * buffer, and returns the address of the new buffer. The function * returns NULL on failure. This function is necessary if a non-NULL * \p udata parameter is supplied, so that property lists containing * the image callbacks can be copied. If the \p udata parameter below * is \c NULL, then this parameter should be \c NULL as well. * * - Signature in #H5FD_file_image_callbacks_t: * \snippet H5FDpublic.h udata_copy_snip * \n * - The \ref H5FD_file_image_callbacks_t.udata_free "udata_free" * callback contains a pointer to a function * that, from the perspective of HDF5, frees a user data block. This * function is necessary if a non-NULL udata parameter is supplied so * that property lists containing image callbacks can be discarded * without a memory leak. If the udata parameter below is \c NULL, * this parameter should be \c NULL as well. * * - Signature in #H5FD_file_image_callbacks_t: * \snippet H5FDpublic.h udata_free_snip * * - \p **udata**, the final field in the #H5FD_file_image_callbacks_t * struct, provides a pointer to user-defined data. This pointer will * be passed to the * \ref H5FD_file_image_callbacks_t.image_malloc "image_malloc", * \ref H5FD_file_image_callbacks_t.image_memcpy "image_memcpy", * \ref H5FD_file_image_callbacks_t.image_realloc "image_realloc", and * \ref H5FD_file_image_callbacks_t.image_free "image_free" callbacks. * Define udata as \c NULL if no user-defined data is provided. * * \since 1.8.9 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pset_file_image_callbacks(hid_t fapl_id, H5FD_file_image_callbacks_t *callbacks_ptr); /** * \ingroup FAPL * * \brief Sets the file locking property values * * \fapl_id * \param[in] use_file_locking Toggle to specify file locking (or not) * \param[in] ignore_when_disabled Toggle to ignore when disabled (or not) * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pset_file_locking() overrides the default file locking flag * setting that was set when the library was configured. * * This setting can be overridden by the \c HDF5_USE_FILE_LOCKING * environment variable. * * File locking is used when creating/opening a file to prevent * problematic file accesses. * * \since 1.10.7 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pset_file_locking(hid_t fapl_id, hbool_t use_file_locking, hbool_t ignore_when_disabled); /** * \ingroup FAPL * * \brief Sets garbage collecting references flag * * \fapl_id * \param[in] gc_ref Flag setting reference garbage collection to on (1) or off (0) * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pset_gc_references() sets the flag for garbage collecting * references for the file. * * Dataset region references and other reference types use space in an * HDF5 file's global heap. If garbage collection is on and the user * passes in an uninitialized value in a reference structure, the heap * might get corrupted. When garbage collection is off, however, and * the user re-uses a reference, the previous heap block will be * orphaned and not returned to the free heap space. * * When garbage collection is on, the user must initialize the * reference structures to 0 or risk heap corruption. * * The default value for garbage collecting references is off. * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pset_gc_references(hid_t fapl_id, unsigned gc_ref); /** * \ingroup FAPL * * \brief Controls the range of library release versions used when creating * objects in a file * * \fapl_id{plist_id} * \param[in] low The earliest version of the library that will be used * for writing objects * \param[in] high The latest version of the library that will be used for * writing objects * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pset_libver_bounds() controls the range of library release * versions that will be used when creating objects in a file. * The object format versions are determined indirectly from the * library release versions specified in the call. * * This property is set in the file access property list * specified by the parameter \p fapl_id. * * The parameter \p low sets the earliest possible format * versions that the library will use when creating objects in * the file. Note that earliest possible is different from * earliest, as some features introduced in library versions * later than 1.0.0 resulted in updates to object formats. * The parameter \p high sets the latest format versions that * the library will be allowed to use when creating objects in * the file. * * The parameters \p low and \p high must be one of the * enumerated values in the #H5F_libver_t struct, which is * defined in H5Fpublic.h. * * The macro #H5F_LIBVER_LATEST is aliased to the highest * enumerated value in #H5F_libver_t, indicating that this is * currently the latest format available. * * The library supports the following five pairs of * (\p low, \p high) combinations as derived from the values * in #H5F_libver_t: * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * *
Value of \p low and \p highResult
\p low=#H5F_LIBVER_EARLIEST
* \p high=#H5F_LIBVER_V18
* \li The library will create objects with the earliest * possible format versions. * \li The library will allow objects to be created with the * latest format versions available to library release 1.8.x. * \li API calls that create objects or features that are * available to versions of the library greater than 1.8.x * release will fail. *
\p low=#H5F_LIBVER_EARLIEST
* \p high=#H5F_LIBVER_V110
* \li The library will create objects with the earliest possible * format versions. * \li The library will allow objects to be created with the latest * format versions available to library release 1.10.x. * Since 1.10.x is also #H5F_LIBVER_LATEST, there is no upper * limit on the format versions to use. For example, if a newer * format version is required to support a feature e.g. virtual * dataset, this setting will allow the object to be created. * \li This is the library default setting and provides the greatest * format compatibility. *
\p low=#H5F_LIBVER_V18
* \p high=#H5F_LIBVER_V18
* \li The library will create objects with the latest format * versions available to library release 1.8.x. * \li API calls that create objects or features that are available * to versions of the library greater than 1.8.x release will * fail. * \li Earlier versions of the library may not be able to access * objects created with this setting.
\p low=#H5F_LIBVER_V18
* \p high=#H5F_LIBVER_V110
* \li The library will create objects with the latest format * versions available to library release 1.8.x. * \li The library will allow objects to be created with the latest * format versions available to library release 1.10.x. * Since 1.10.x is also #H5F_LIBVER_LATEST, there is no upper * limit on the format versions to use. For example, if a * newer format version is required to support a feature e.g. * virtual dataset, this setting will allow the object to be * created. * \li Earlier versions of the library may not be able to access * objects created with this setting.
\p low=#H5F_LIBVER_V110
* \p high=#H5F_LIBVER_V110 *
* \li The library will create objects with the latest format * versions available to library release 1.10.x. * \li The library will allow objects to be created with the latest * format versions available to library release 1.10.x. * Since 1.10.x is also #H5F_LIBVER_LATEST, there is no upper * limit on the format versions to use. For example, if a * newer format version is required to support a feature e.g. * virtual dataset, this setting will allow the object to be * created. * \li This setting allows users to take advantage of the latest * features and performance enhancements in the library. * However, objects written with this setting may be * accessible to a smaller range of library versions than * would be the case if low is set to #H5F_LIBVER_EARLIEST. * \li Earlier versions of the library may not be able to access * objects created with this * setting. *
* * \version 1.10.2 #H5F_LIBVER_V18 added to the enumerated defines in * #H5F_libver_t. * * \since 1.8.0 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pset_libver_bounds(hid_t plist_id, H5F_libver_t low, H5F_libver_t high); /** * \ingroup FAPL * * \brief Set the initial metadata cache configuration in the indicated File * Access Property List to the supplied value * * \fapl_id{plist_id} * \param[in] config_ptr Pointer to the instance of \p H5AC_cache_config_t * containing the desired configuration * \return \herr_t * * \details The fields of the #H5AC_cache_config_t structure are shown * below: * \snippet H5ACpublic.h H5AC_cache_config_t_snip * \click4more * * \details H5Pset_mdc_config() attempts to set the initial metadata cache * configuration to the supplied value. It will fail if an invalid * configuration is detected. This configuration is used when the file * is opened. * * See the overview of the metadata cache in the special topics section * of the user manual for details on what is being configured. If you * have not read and understood that documentation, you really should * not be using this API call. * * \since 1.8.0 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pset_mdc_config(hid_t plist_id, H5AC_cache_config_t *config_ptr); /** * \ingroup FAPL * * \brief Sets metadata cache logging options * * \fapl_id{plist_id} * \param[in] is_enabled Whether logging is enabled * \param[in] location Location of log in UTF-8/ASCII (file path/name) * (On Windows, this must be ASCII) * \param[in] start_on_access Whether the logging will begin as soon as the * file is opened or created * * \return \herr_t * * \details The metadata cache is a central part of the HDF5 library through * which all file metadata reads and writes take place. File metadata * is normally invisible to the user and is used by the library for * purposes such as locating and indexing data. File metadata should * not be confused with user metadata, which consists of attributes * created by users and attached to HDF5 objects such as datasets via * H5A API calls. * * Due to the complexity of the cache, a trace/logging feature has * been created that can be used by HDF5 developers for debugging and * performance analysis. The functions that control this functionality * will normally be of use to a very limited number of developers * outside of The HDF Group. The functions have been documented to * help users create logs that can be sent with bug reports. * * Control of the log functionality is straightforward. Logging is * enabled via the H5Pset_mdc_log_options() function, * which will modify the file access property list used to open or * create a file. This function has a flag that determines whether * logging begins at file open or starts in a paused state. Log * messages can then be controlled via the H5Fstart_mdc_logging() * and H5Fstop_mdc_logging() function. * * H5Pget_mdc_log_options() can be used to examine a file access * property list, and H5Fget_mdc_logging_status() will return the * current state of the logging flags. * * The log format is described in [Metadata Cache Logging] * (https://portal.hdfgroup.org/display/HDF5/Fine-tuning+the+Metadata+Cache). * * \since 1.10.0 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pset_mdc_log_options(hid_t plist_id, hbool_t is_enabled, const char *location, hbool_t start_on_access); /** * \ingroup FAPL * * \brief Sets the minimum metadata block size * * \fapl_id{fapl_id} * \param[in] size Minimum size, in bytes, of metadata block allocations * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pset_meta_block_size() sets the minimum size, in bytes, of * metadata block allocations when #H5FD_FEAT_AGGREGATE_METADATA is set by a VFL * driver. * Each raw metadata block is initially allocated to be of the given size. * Specific metadata objects (e.g., object headers, local heaps, B-trees) are then * sub-allocated from this block. * * The default setting is 2048 bytes, meaning that the library will * attempt to aggregate metadata in at least 2K blocks in the file. * Setting the value to zero (\Code{0}) with this function will turn * off metadata aggregation, even if the VFL driver attempts to use the * metadata aggregation strategy. * * Metadata aggregation reduces the number of small data objects in the file that * would otherwise be required for metadata. The aggregated block of metadata is * usually written in a single write action and always in a contiguous block, * potentially significantly improving library and application performance. * * \since 1.4.0 */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pset_meta_block_size(hid_t fapl_id, hsize_t size); /** * \ingroup FAPL * * \brief Sets the number of read attempts in a file access property list * * \fapl_id{plist_id} * \param[in] attempts The number of read attempts. Must be a value greater than \Code{0} * * \return \herr_t * * \return Failure Modes: * - When the user sets the number of read attempts to \Code{0}. * - When the input property list is not a file access property list. * - When the library is unable to set the number of read attempts in the file access property list. * * \details H5Pset_metadata_read_attempts() sets the number of reads that the * library will try when reading checksummed metadata in an HDF5 file opened * with SWMR access. When reading such metadata, the library will compare the * checksum computed for the metadata just read with the checksum stored within * the piece of checksum. When performing SWMR operations on a file, the * checksum check might fail when the library reads data on a system that is not * atomic. To remedy such situations, the library will repeatedly read the piece * of metadata until the check passes or finally fails the read when the allowed * number of attempts is reached. * * The number of read attempts used by the library will depend on how the file is * opened and whether the user sets the number of read attempts via this routine: * - For a file opened with SWMR access: * - If the user sets the number of attempts to \Code{N}, the library will use \Code{N}. * - If the user does not set the number of attempts, the library will use the * default for SWMR access (\Code{100}). * - For a file opened with non-SWMR access, the library will always use the default * for non-SWMR access (\Code{1}). The value set via this routine does not have any effect * during non-SWMR access. * * \b Example: The first example illustrates the case in setting the number of read attempts for a file * opened with SWMR access. * * \snippet H5Pset_metadata_read_attempts.c SWMR Access * * \b Example: The second example illustrates the case in setting the number of * read attempts for a file opened with non-SWMR access. The value * set in the file access property list does not have any effect. * * \snippet H5Pset_metadata_read_attempts.c non-SWMR Access * * \note \b Motivation: On a system that is not atomic, the library might * possibly read inconsistent metadata with checksum when performing * single-writer/multiple-reader (SWMR) operations for an HDF5 file. Upon * encountering such situations, the library will try reading the metadata * again to obtain consistent data. This routine provides the means to set * the number of read attempts other than the library default. * * \since 1.10.0 */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pset_metadata_read_attempts(hid_t plist_id, unsigned attempts); /** * \ingroup FAPL * * \brief Specifies type of data to be accessed via the \Code{MULTI} driver, * enabling more direct access * * \fapl_id{fapl_id} * \param[in] type Type of data to be accessed * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pset_multi_type() sets the \Emph{type of data} property in the file * access property list \p fapl_id. This setting enables a user * application to specify the type of data the application wishes to * access so that the application can retrieve a file handle for * low-level access to the particular member of a set of \Code{MULTI} * files in which that type of data is stored. The file handle is * retrieved with a separate call to H5Fget_vfd_handle() (or, in special * circumstances, to H5FDget_vfd_handle(); see \ref VFL. * * The type of data specified in \p type may be one of the following: * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * *
#H5FD_MEM_SUPER Super block data
#H5FD_MEM_BTREE B-tree data
#H5FD_MEM_DRAW Dataset raw data
#H5FD_MEM_GHEAP Global heap data
#H5FD_MEM_LHEAP Local Heap data
#H5FD_MEM_OHDR Object header data
* * This function is for use only when accessing an HDF5 file written as a set of * files with the \Code{MULTI} file driver. * * \since 1.6.0 */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pset_multi_type(hid_t fapl_id, H5FD_mem_t type); /** * \ingroup FAPL * * \brief Sets a callback function to invoke when an object flush occurs in the file * * \fapl_id{plist_id} * \op{func} * \op_data_in{udata} * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pset_object_flush_cb() sets the callback function to invoke in the * file access property list \p plist_id whenever an object flush occurs in * the file. Library objects are group, dataset, and committed * datatype. * * The callback function \p func must conform to the prototype defined below: * \code * typedef herr_t (*H5F_flush_cb_t)(hid_t object_id, void *user_data) * \endcode * * The parameters of the callback function, per the above prototypes, are defined as follows: * - \Code{object_id} is the identifier of the object which has just been flushed. * - \Code{user_data} is the user-defined input data for the callback function. * * \b Example: The example below illustrates the usage of this routine to set * the callback function to invoke when an object flush occurs. * * \include H5Pset_object_flush_cb.c * * \since 1.10.0 */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pset_object_flush_cb(hid_t plist_id, H5F_flush_cb_t func, void *udata); /** * \ingroup FAPL * * \brief Sets the maximum size of the data sieve buffer * * \fapl_id{fapl_id} * \param[in] size Maximum size, in bytes, of data sieve buffer * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pset_sieve_buf_size() sets \p size, the maximum size in bytes of the * data sieve buffer, which is used by file drivers that are capable of * using data sieving. * * The data sieve buffer is used when performing I/O on datasets in the * file. Using a buffer which is large enough to hold several pieces of * the dataset being read in for hyperslab selections boosts * performance by quite a bit. * * The default value is set to 64KB, indicating that file I/O for raw * data reads and writes will occur in at least 64KB blocks. Setting * the value to zero (\Code{0}) with this API function will turn off * the data sieving, even if the VFL driver attempts to use that * strategy. * * Internally, the library checks the storage sizes of the datasets in * the file. It picks the smaller one between the size from the file * access property and the size of the dataset to allocate the sieve * buffer for the dataset in order to save memory usage. * * \version 1.6.0 The \p size parameter has changed from type \Code{hsize_t} to \Code{size_t}. * * \since 1.4.0 */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pset_sieve_buf_size(hid_t fapl_id, size_t size); /** * \ingroup FAPL * * \brief Sets the size of a contiguous block reserved for small data * * \fapl_id{fapl_id} * \param[in] size Maximum size, in bytes, of the small data block. The default size is \Code{2048}. * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pset_small_data_block_size() reserves blocks of \p size bytes for the * contiguous storage of the raw data portion of \Emph{small} datasets. The * HDF5 library then writes the raw data from small datasets to this * reserved space, thus reducing unnecessary discontinuities within * blocks of meta data and improving I/O performance. * * A small data block is actually allocated the first time a qualifying * small dataset is written to the file. Space for the raw data portion * of this small dataset is suballocated within the small data block. * The raw data from each subsequent small dataset is also written to * the small data block until it is filled; additional small data * blocks are allocated as required. * * The HDF5 library employs an algorithm that determines whether I/O * performance is likely to benefit from the use of this mechanism with * each dataset as storage space is allocated in the file. A larger * \p size will result in this mechanism being employed with larger * datasets. * * The small data block size is set as an allocation property in the * file access property list identified by \p fapl_id. * * Setting \p size to zero (\Code{0}) disables the small data block mechanism. * * \since 1.4.4 */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pset_small_data_block_size(hid_t fapl_id, hsize_t size); /** * \ingroup FAPL * * \brief Set the file VOL connector for a file access property list * * \fapl_id{plist_id} * \param[in] new_vol_id VOL connector identifier * \param[in] new_vol_info Optional VOL information * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pset_vol() sets the VOL connector \p new_vol_id for a file access * property list \p plist_id using the (optional) VOL information in * \p new_vol_info. * * \since 1.12.0 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pset_vol(hid_t plist_id, hid_t new_vol_id, const void *new_vol_info); /** * \ingroup FAPL * * \brief Query the capability flags for the VOL connector that will be used * with this file access property list (FAPL). * * \fapl_id{plist_id} * \param[out] cap_flags Flags that indicate the VOL connector capabilities * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pget_vol_cap_flags() queries the current VOL connector information * for a FAPL to retrieve the capability flags for the VOL * connector stack, as will be used by a file open or create * operation that uses this FAPL. * * \note This routine supports the use of the HDF5_VOL_CONNECTOR environment * variable to override the VOL connector set programmatically for the * FAPL (with H5Pset_vol). * * \note The H5VL_CAP_FLAG_ASYNC flag can be checked to see if asynchronous * operations are supported by the VOL connector stack. * * \since 1.13.0 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pget_vol_cap_flags(hid_t plist_id, uint64_t *cap_flags); #ifdef H5_HAVE_PARALLEL /** * \ingroup GAPL * * \brief Sets metadata I/O mode for read operations to collective or independent (default) * * \gacpl_id * \param[in] is_collective Boolean value indicating whether metadata reads are collective * (\Code{1}) or independent (\Code{0}). * Default mode: Independent (\Code{0}) * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pset_all_coll_metadata_ops() sets the metadata I/O mode for read * operations in the access property list \p plist_id. * * When engaging in parallel I/O, all metadata write operations must be * collective. If \p is_collective is \Code{1}, this property specifies * that the HDF5 library will perform all metadata read operations * collectively; if \p is_collective is \Code{0}, such operations may * be performed independently. * * Users must be aware that several HDF5 operations can potentially * issue metadata reads. These include opening a dataset, datatype, or * group; reading an attribute; or issuing a \Emph{get info} call such * as getting information for a group with H5Fget_info(). Collective * I/O requirements must be kept in mind when issuing such calls in the * context of parallel I/O. * * If this property is collective on a file access property list that * is used in creating or opening a file, then the HDF5 library will * assume that all metadata read operations issued on that file * identifier will be issued collectively from all ranks irrespective * of the individual setting of a particular operation. If this * assumption is not adhered to, corruption will be introduced in the * metadata cache and HDF5’s behavior will be undefined. * * Alternatively, a user may wish to avoid setting this property * globally on the file access property list, and individually set it * on particular object access property lists (dataset, group, link, * datatype, attribute access property lists) for certain operations. * This will indicate that only the operations issued with such an * access property list will be called collectively and other * operations may potentially be called independently. There are, * however, several HDF5 operations that can issue metadata reads but * have no property list in their function signatures to allow passing * the collective requirement property. For those operations, the only * option is to set the global collective requirement property on the * file access property list; otherwise the metadata reads that can be * triggered from those operations will be done independently by each * process. * * Functions that do not accommodate an access property list but that * might issue metadata reads are listed in \ref maybe_metadata_reads. * * \attention As noted above, corruption will be introduced into the metadata * cache and HDF5 library behavior will be undefined when both of the following * conditions exist: * - A file is created or opened with a file access property list in which the * collective metadata I/O property is set to \Code{1}. * - Any function is called that triggers an independent metadata read while the * file remains open with that file access property list. * * \attention An approach that avoids this corruption risk is described above. * * \sa_metadata_ops * * \since 1.10.0 */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pset_all_coll_metadata_ops(hid_t plist_id, hbool_t is_collective); /** * \ingroup GAPL * * \brief Retrieves metadata read mode setting * * \gacpl_id * \param[out] is_collective Pointer to a buffer containing the Boolean value indicating whether metadata * reads are collective (\Code{>0}) or independent (\Code{0}). * Default mode: Independent (\Code{0}) * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pget_all_coll_metadata_ops() retrieves the collective metadata read setting from the access * property list \p plist_id into \p is_collective. * * \sa_metadata_ops * * \since 1.10.0 */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pget_all_coll_metadata_ops(hid_t plist_id, hbool_t *is_collective); /** * \ingroup FAPL * * \brief Sets metadata write mode to collective or independent (default) * * \fapl_id{plist_id} * \param[out] is_collective Boolean value indicating whether metadata * writes are collective (\Code{>0}) or independent (\Code{0}). * \Emph{Default mode:} Independent (\Code{0}) * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pset_coll_metadata_write() tells the HDF5 library whether to * perform metadata writes collectively (1) or independently (0). * * If collective access is selected, then on a flush of the metadata * cache, all processes will divide the metadata cache entries to be * flushed evenly among themselves and issue a single MPI-IO collective * write operation. This is the preferred method when the size of the * metadata created by the application is large. * * If independent access is selected, the library uses the default * method for doing metadata I/O either from process zero or * independently from each process. * * \sa_metadata_ops * * \since 1.10.0 */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pset_coll_metadata_write(hid_t plist_id, hbool_t is_collective); /** * \ingroup FAPL * * \brief Retrieves metadata write mode setting * * \fapl_id{plist_id} * \param[out] is_collective Pointer to a boolean value indicating whether * metadata writes are collective (\Code{>0}) or independent (\Code{0}). * \Emph{Default mode:} Independent (\Code{0}) * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pget_coll_metadata_write() retrieves the collective metadata write * setting from the file access property into \p is_collective. * * \sa_metadata_ops * * \since 1.10.0 */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pget_coll_metadata_write(hid_t plist_id, hbool_t *is_collective); /** * \ingroup FAPL * * \brief Get the MPI communicator and info * * \fapl_id * \param[out] comm MPI communicator * \param[out] info MPI info object * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pget_mpi_params() gets the MPI communicator and info stored in * the file access property list \p fapl_id. * * \todo When was this introduced? * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pget_mpi_params(hid_t fapl_id, MPI_Comm *comm, MPI_Info *info); /** * \ingroup FAPL * * \brief Set the MPI communicator and info * * \fapl_id * \param[in] comm MPI communicator * \param[in] info MPI info object * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pset_mpi_params() sets the MPI communicator and info stored in * the file access property list \p fapl_id. * * \todo When was this introduced? * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pset_mpi_params(hid_t fapl_id, MPI_Comm comm, MPI_Info info); #endif /* H5_HAVE_PARALLEL */ /** * \ingroup FAPL * * \brief Sets the metadata cache image option for a file access property list * * \fapl_id{plist_id} * \param[out] config_ptr Pointer to metadata cache image configuration values * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pset_mdc_image_config() sets the metadata cache image option with * configuration values specified by \p config_ptr for the file access * property list specified in \p plist_id. * * #H5AC_cache_image_config_t is defined as follows: * \snippet H5ACpublic.h H5AC_cache_image_config_t_snip * \click4more * * \par Limitations: While it is an obvious error to request a cache image when * opening the file read only, it is not in general possible to test for * this error in the H5Pset_mdc_image_config() call. Rather than fail the * subsequent file open, the library silently ignores the file image * request in this case.\n It is also an error to request a cache image on * a file that does not support superblock extension messages (i.e. a * superblock version less than 2). As above, it is not always possible to * detect this error in the H5Pset_mdc_image_config() call, and thus the * request for a cache image will fail silently in this case as well.\n * Creation of cache images is currently disabled in parallel -- as above, * any request for a cache image in this context will fail silently.\n * Files with cache images may be read in parallel applications, but note * that the load of the cache image is a collective operation triggered by * the first operation that accesses metadata after file open (or, if * persistent free space managers are enabled, on the first allocation or * deallocation of file space, or read of file space manager status, * whichever comes first). Thus the parallel process may deadlock if any * process does not participate in this access.\n * In long sequences of file closes and opens, infrequently accessed * metadata can accumulate in the cache image to the point where the cost * of storing and restoring this metadata exceeds the benefit of retaining * frequently used metadata in the cache image. When implemented, the * #H5AC_cache_image_config_t::entry_ageout should address this problem. In * the interim, not requesting a cache image every n file close/open cycles * may be an acceptable work around. The choice of \c n will be driven by * application behavior, but \Code{n = 10} seems a good starting point. * * \since 1.10.1 */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pset_mdc_image_config(hid_t plist_id, H5AC_cache_image_config_t *config_ptr); /** * \ingroup FAPL * * \brief Sets the maximum size for the page buffer and the minimum percentage * for metadata and raw data pages * * \fapl_id{plist_id} * \param[in] buf_size Maximum size, in bytes, of the page buffer * \param[in] min_meta_per Minimum metadata percentage to keep in the page buffer * before allowing pages containing metadata to be evicted (Default is 0) * \param[in] min_raw_per Minimum raw data percentage to keep in the page buffer * before allowing pages containing raw data to be evicted (Default is 0) * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pset_page_buffer_size() sets buf_size, the maximum size in bytes * of the page buffer. The default value is zero, meaning that page * buffering is disabled. When a non-zero page buffer size is set, the * library will enable page buffering if that size is larger or equal * than a single page size if a paged file space strategy is enabled * using the functions H5Pset_file_space_strategy() and * H5Pset_file_space_page_size(). * * The page buffer layer captures all I/O requests before they are * issued to the VFD and "caches" them in fixed sized pages. Once the * total number of pages exceeds the page buffer size, the library * evicts pages from the page buffer by writing them to the VFD. At * file close, the page buffer is flushed writing all the pages to the * file. * * If a non-zero page buffer size is set, and the file space strategy * is not set to paged or the page size for the file space strategy is * larger than the page buffer size, the subsequent call to H5Fcreate() * or H5Fopen() using the \p plist_id will fail. * * The function also allows setting the minimum percentage of pages for * metadata and raw data to prevent a certain type of data to evict hot * data of the other type. * * \since 1.10.1 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pset_page_buffer_size(hid_t plist_id, size_t buf_size, unsigned min_meta_per, unsigned min_raw_per); /* Dataset creation property list (DCPL) routines */ /** * \ingroup DCPL * * \brief Determines whether fill value is defined * * \dcpl_id{plist} * \param[out] status Status of fill value in property list * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pfill_value_defined() determines whether a fill value is * defined in the dataset creation property list \p plist. Valid * values returned in status are as follows: * * * * * * * * * * * * * * *
#H5D_FILL_VALUE_UNDEFINEDFill value is undefined.
#H5D_FILL_VALUE_DEFAULTFill value is the library default.
#H5D_FILL_VALUE_USER_DEFINEDFill value is defined by the application.
* * \since 1.6.0 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pfill_value_defined(hid_t plist, H5D_fill_value_t *status); /** * \ingroup DCPL * * \brief Retrieves the timing for storage space allocation * * \dcpl_id{plist_id} * \param[out] alloc_time The timing setting for allocating dataset * storage space * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pget_alloc_time() retrieves the timing for allocating storage * space for a dataset's raw data. This property is set in the * dataset creation property list \p plist_id. The timing setting * is returned in \p alloc_time as one of the following values: * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * *
#H5D_ALLOC_TIME_DEFAULT
 
Uses the default allocation time, based on the dataset * storage method.
See the \p alloc_time description in * H5Pset_alloc_time() for default allocation times for * various storage methods.
#H5D_ALLOC_TIME_EARLYAll space is allocated when the dataset is created.
#H5D_ALLOC_TIME_INCRSpace is allocated incrementally as data is written * to the dataset.
#H5D_ALLOC_TIME_LATEAll space is allocated when data is first written to * the dataset.
* * \note H5Pget_alloc_time() is designed to work in concert with the * dataset fill value and fill value write time properties, set * with the functions H5Pget_fill_value() and H5Pget_fill_time(). * * \since 1.6.0 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pget_alloc_time(hid_t plist_id, H5D_alloc_time_t *alloc_time /*out*/); /** * \ingroup DCPL * * \brief Retrieves the size of chunks for the raw data of a chunked * layout dataset * * \dcpl_id{plist_id} * \param[in] max_ndims Size of the \p dims array * \param[out] dim Array to store the chunk dimensions * * \return Returns chunk dimensionality if successful; * otherwise returns a negative value. * * \details H5Pget_chunk() retrieves the size of chunks for the raw data * of a chunked layout dataset. This function is only valid for * dataset creation property lists. At most, \p max_ndims elements * of \p dim will be initialized. * * \since 1.0.0 * */ H5_DLL int H5Pget_chunk(hid_t plist_id, int max_ndims, hsize_t dim[] /*out*/); /** * * \ingroup DCPL * * \brief Retrieves the edge chunk option setting from a dataset creation * property list * * \dcpl_id{plist_id} * \param[out] opts Edge chunk option flag. Valid values are described in * H5Pset_chunk_opts(). The option status can be * retrieved using the bitwise AND operator ( & ). For * example, the expression * (opts&#H5D_CHUNK_DONT_FILTER_PARTIAL_CHUNKS) will * evaluate to #H5D_CHUNK_DONT_FILTER_PARTIAL_CHUNKS if * that option has been enabled. Otherwise, it will * evaluate to 0 (zero). * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pget_chunk_opts() retrieves the edge chunk option setting * stored in the dataset creation property list \p plist_id. * * \since 1.10.0 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pget_chunk_opts(hid_t plist_id, unsigned *opts); /** * \ingroup DCPL * * \brief Retrieves the setting for whether or not to create minimized * dataset object headers * * \dcpl_id * \param[out] minimize Flag indicating whether the library will or will * not create minimized dataset object headers * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pget_dset_no_attrs_hint() retrieves the * no dataset attributes hint setting for the dataset * creation property list \p dcpl_id. This setting is used to * inform the library to create minimized dataset object headers * when TRUE. The setting value is returned in the boolean pointer * \p minimize. * * \since 1.10.5 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pget_dset_no_attrs_hint(hid_t dcpl_id, hbool_t *minimize); /** * \ingroup DCPL * * \brief Returns information about an external file * * \dcpl_id{plist_id} * \param[in] idx External file index * \param[in] name_size Maximum length of \p name array * \param[out] name Name of the external file * \param[out] offset Pointer to a location to return an offset value * \param[out] size Pointer to a location to return the size of the * external file data * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pget_external() returns information about an external file. * The external file is specified by its index, \p idx, which * is a number from zero to N-1, where N is the value returned * by H5Pget_external_count(). At most \p name_size characters * are copied into the \p name array. If the external file name * is longer than \p name_size with the null terminator, the * return value is not null terminated (similar to strncpy()). * * If \p name_size is zero or \p name is the null pointer, the * external file name is not returned. If \p offset or \p size * are null pointers then the corresponding information is not * returned. * * \note On Windows, off_t is typically a 32-bit signed long value, which * limits the valid offset that can be returned to 2 GiB. * * \version 1.6.4 \p idx parameter type changed to unsigned. * \since 1.0.0 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pget_external(hid_t plist_id, unsigned idx, size_t name_size, char *name /*out*/, off_t *offset /*out*/, hsize_t *size /*out*/); /** * \ingroup DCPL * * \brief Returns the number of external files for a dataset * * \dcpl_id{plist_id} * * \return Returns the number of external files if successful; otherwise * returns a negative value. * * \details H5Pget_external_count() returns the number of external files * for the specified dataset. * * \since 1.0.0 * */ H5_DLL int H5Pget_external_count(hid_t plist_id); /** * \ingroup DCPL * * \brief Retrieves the time when fill values are written to a dataset * * \dcpl_id{plist_id} * \param[out] fill_time Setting for the timing of writing fill values to * the dataset * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pget_fill_time() examines the dataset creation property list * \p plist_id to determine when fill values are to be written to * a dataset. Valid values returned in \p fill_time are as * follows: * * * * * * * * * * * * * * *
#H5D_FILL_TIME_IFSETFill values are written to the dataset when storage * space is allocated only if there is a user-defined fill * value, i.e., one set with H5Pset_fill_value(). (Default) *
#H5D_FILL_TIME_ALLOCFill values are written to the dataset when storage * space is allocated.
#H5D_FILL_TIME_NEVERFill values are never written to the dataset.
* * \note H5Pget_fill_time() is designed to work in coordination with the * dataset fill value and dataset storage allocation time properties, * retrieved with the functions H5Pget_fill_value() and * H5Pget_alloc_time(). * * \since 1.6.0 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pget_fill_time(hid_t plist_id, H5D_fill_time_t *fill_time /*out*/); /** * \ingroup DCPL * * \brief Retrieves a dataset fill value * * \dcpl_id{plist_id} * \param[in] type_id Datatype identifier for the value passed via * \p value * \param[out] value Pointer to buffer to contain the returned * fill value * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pget_fill_value() returns the dataset fill value defined in * the dataset creation property list \p plist_id. The fill value * is returned through the \p value pointer and will be converted * to the datatype specified by \p type_id. This datatype may * differ from the fill value datatype in the property list, but * the HDF5 library must be able to convert between the two * datatypes. * * If the fill value is undefined, i.e., set to NULL in the * property list, H5Pget_fill_value() will return an error. * H5Pfill_value_defined() should be used to check for this * condition before H5Pget_fill_value() is called. * * Memory must be allocated by the calling application. * * \note H5Pget_fill_value() is designed to coordinate with the dataset * storage allocation time and fill value write time properties, * which can be retrieved with the functions H5Pget_alloc_time() * and H5Pget_fill_time(), respectively. * * \since 1.0.0 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pget_fill_value(hid_t plist_id, hid_t type_id, void *value /*out*/); /** * \ingroup DCPL * * \brief Returns the layout of the raw data for a dataset * * \dcpl_id{plist_id} * * \return Returns the layout type (a non-negative value) of a dataset * creation property list if successful. Valid return values are: * - #H5D_COMPACT: Raw data is stored in the object header in the * file. * - #H5D_CONTIGUOUS: Raw data is stored separately from the object * header in one contiguous chunk in the file. * - #H5D_CHUNKED: Raw data is stored separately from the object * header in chunks in separate locations in the * file. * - #H5D_VIRTUAL: Raw data is drawn from multiple datasets in * different files. * \return * Otherwise, returns a negative value indicating failure. * * \details H5Pget_layout() returns the layout of the raw data for a * dataset. This function is only valid for dataset creation * property lists. * * Note that a compact storage layout may affect writing data to * the dataset with parallel applications. See the H5Dwrite() * documentation for details. * * \version 1.10.0 #H5D_VIRTUAL added in this release. * * \since 1.0.0 * */ H5_DLL H5D_layout_t H5Pget_layout(hid_t plist_id); /** * \ingroup DCPL * * \brief Gets the number of mappings for the virtual dataset * * \dcpl_id * \param[out] count The number of mappings * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pget_virtual_count() gets the number of mappings for a * virtual dataset that has the creation property list specified * by \p dcpl_id. * * \see_virtual * * \since 1.10.0 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pget_virtual_count(hid_t dcpl_id, size_t *count /*out*/); /** * \ingroup DCPL * * \brief Gets the name of a source dataset used in the mapping * * \dcpl_id * \param[in] index Mapping index. The value of \p index is 0 (zero) or * greater and less than \p count * (0 ≤ \p index < \p count), where \p count is the * number of mappings returned by H5Pget_virtual_count(). * \param[out] name A buffer containing the name of the source dataset * \param[in] size The size, in bytes, of the name buffer. Must be the * size of the dataset name in bytes plus 1 for a NULL * terminator * * \return Returns the length of the dataset name if successful; * otherwise returns a negative value. * * \details H5Pget_virtual_dsetname() takes the dataset creation property * list for the virtual dataset, \p dcpl_id, the mapping index, * \p index, the size of the dataset name for a source dataset, * \p size, and retrieves the name of the source dataset used in * the mapping. * * Up to \p size characters of the dataset name are returned in * \p name; additional characters, if any, are not returned to * the user application. * * If the length of the dataset name, which determines the * required value of \p size, is unknown, a preliminary call * to H5Pget_virtual_dsetname() with the last two parameters * set to NULL and zero respectively can be made. The return * value of this call will be the size in bytes of the dataset * name. That value, plus 1 for a NULL terminator, must then be * assigned to \p size for a second H5Pget_virtual_dsetname() * call, which will retrieve the actual dataset name. * * \see_virtual * * \since 1.10.0 * */ H5_DLL ssize_t H5Pget_virtual_dsetname(hid_t dcpl_id, size_t index, char *name /*out*/, size_t size); /** * \ingroup DCPL * * \brief Gets the filename of a source dataset used in the mapping * * \dcpl_id * \param[in] index Mapping index. The value of \p index is 0 (zero) or * greater and less than \p count * (0 ≤ \p index < \p count), where \p count is the * number of mappings returned by H5Pget_virtual_count(). * \param[out] name A buffer containing the name of the file containing * the source dataset * \param[in] size The size, in bytes, of the name buffer. Must be the * size of the filename in bytes plus 1 for a NULL * terminator * * \return Returns the length of the filename if successful; otherwise * returns a negative value. * * \details H5Pget_virtual_filename() takes the dataset creation property * list for the virtual dataset, \p dcpl_id, the mapping index, * \p index, the size of the filename for a source dataset, * \p size, and retrieves the name of the file for a source dataset * used in the mapping. * * Up to \p size characters of the filename are returned in * \p name; additional characters, if any, are not returned to * the user application. * * If the length of the filename, which determines the required * value of \p size, is unknown, a preliminary call to * H5Pget_virtual_filename() with the last two parameters set * to NULL and zero respectively can be made. The return value * of this call will be the size in bytes of the filename. That * value, plus 1 for a NULL terminator, must then be assigned to * \p size for a second H5Pget_virtual_filename() call, which * will retrieve the actual filename. * * \see_virtual * * \since 1.10.0 * */ H5_DLL ssize_t H5Pget_virtual_filename(hid_t dcpl_id, size_t index, char *name /*out*/, size_t size); /** * \ingroup DCPL * * \brief Gets a dataspace identifier for the selection within the source * dataset used in the mapping * * \dcpl_id * \param[in] index Mapping index. The value of \p index is 0 (zero) or * greater and less than \p count * (0 ≤ \p index < \p count), where \p count is the number * of mappings returned by H5Pget_virtual_count(). * * \return \hid_t{valid dataspace identifier} * * \details H5Pget_virtual_srcspace() takes the dataset creation property * list for the virtual dataset, \p dcpl_id, and the mapping * index, \p index, and returns a dataspace identifier for the * selection within the source dataset used in the mapping. * * \see_virtual * * \since 1.10.0 * */ H5_DLL hid_t H5Pget_virtual_srcspace(hid_t dcpl_id, size_t index); /** * \ingroup DCPL * * \brief Gets a dataspace identifier for the selection within the virtual * dataset used in the mapping * * \dcpl_id * \param[in] index Mapping index. The value of \p index is 0 (zero) or * greater and less than \p count * (0 ≤ \p index < \p count), where \p count is the number * of mappings returned by H5Pget_virtual_count() * * \return \hid_t{valid dataspace identifier} * * \details H5Pget_virtual_vspace() takes the dataset creation property * list for the virtual dataset, \p dcpl_id, and the mapping * index, \p index, and returns a dataspace identifier for the * selection within the virtual dataset used in the mapping. * * \see_virtual * * \since 1.10.0 * */ H5_DLL hid_t H5Pget_virtual_vspace(hid_t dcpl_id, size_t index); /** * \ingroup DCPL * * \brief Sets the timing for storage space allocation * * \dcpl_id{plist_id} * \param[in] alloc_time When to allocate dataset storage space * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pset_alloc_time() sets up the timing for the allocation of * storage space for a dataset's raw data. This property is set * in the dataset creation property list \p plist_id. Timing is * specified in \p alloc_time with one of the following values: * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * *
#H5D_ALLOC_TIME_DEFAULTAllocate dataset storage space at the default time
* (Defaults differ by storage method.)
#H5D_ALLOC_TIME_EARLYAllocate all space when the dataset is created
* (Default for compact datasets.)
#H5D_ALLOC_TIME_INCRAllocate space incrementally, as data is written to * the dataset
(Default for chunked storage datasets.) * * \li Chunked datasets: Storage space allocation for each * chunk is deferred until data is written to the chunk. * \li Contiguous datasets: Incremental storage space * allocation for contiguous data is treated as late * allocation. * \li Compact datasets: Incremental allocation is not * allowed with compact datasets; H5Pset_alloc_time() * will return an error.
#H5D_ALLOC_TIME_LATEAllocate all space when data is first written to the * dataset
* (Default for contiguous datasets.)
* * \note H5Pset_alloc_time() is designed to work in concert with the * dataset fill value and fill value write time properties, set * with the functions H5Pset_fill_value() and H5Pset_fill_time(). * * \note See H5Dcreate() for further cross-references. * * \since 1.6.0 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pset_alloc_time(hid_t plist_id, H5D_alloc_time_t alloc_time); /** * \ingroup DCPL * * \brief Sets the size of the chunks used to store a chunked layout * dataset * * \dcpl_id{plist_id} * \param[in] ndims The number of dimensions of each chunk * \param[in] dim An array defining the size, in dataset elements, of * each chunk * * \return \herr_t * \details H5Pset_chunk() sets the size of the chunks used to store a * chunked layout dataset. This function is only valid for dataset * creation property lists. * * The \p ndims parameter currently must be the same size as the * rank of the dataset. * * The values of the \p dim array define the size of the chunks * to store the dataset's raw data. The unit of measure for \p dim * values is dataset elements. * * As a side-effect of this function, the layout of the dataset is * changed to #H5D_CHUNKED, if it is not already so set. * * \note Chunk size cannot exceed the size of a fixed-size dataset. For * example, a dataset consisting of a 5x4 fixed-size array cannot be * defined with 10x10 chunks. Chunk maximums: * - The maximum number of elements in a chunk is 232-1 which * is equal to 4,294,967,295. If the number of elements in a chunk is * set via H5Pset_chunk() to a value greater than 232-1, * then H5Pset_chunk() will fail. * - The maximum size for any chunk is 4GB. If a chunk that is larger * than 4GB attempts to be written with H5Dwrite(), then H5Dwrite() * will fail. * * \see H5Pset_layout(), H5Dwrite() * * \since 1.0.0 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pset_chunk(hid_t plist_id, int ndims, const hsize_t dim[/*ndims*/]); /** * \ingroup DCPL * * \brief Sets the edge chunk option in a dataset creation property list * * \dcpl_id{plist_id} * \param[in] opts Edge chunk option flag. Valid values are: * \li #H5D_CHUNK_DONT_FILTER_PARTIAL_CHUNKS * When enabled, filters are not applied to partial * edge chunks. When disabled, partial edge chunks are * filtered. Enabling this option will improve * performance when appending to the dataset and, when * compression filters are used, prevent reallocation * of these chunks. Datasets created with this option * enabled will be inaccessible with HDF5 library * versions before Release 1.10. Default: \e Disabled * \li 0 (zero) Disables option; partial edge chunks * will be compressed. * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pset_chunk_opts() sets the edge chunk option in the * dataset creation property list \p dcpl_id. * * The available option is detailed in the parameters section. * Only chunks that are not completely filled by the dataset’s * dataspace are affected by this option. Such chunks are * referred to as partial edge chunks. * * \b Motivation: H5Pset_chunk_opts() is used to specify storage * options for chunks on the edge of a dataset’s dataspace. This * capability allows the user to tune performance in cases where * the dataset size may not be a multiple of the chunk size and * the handling of partial edge chunks can impact performance. * * \since 1.10.0 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pset_chunk_opts(hid_t plist_id, unsigned opts); /** * \ingroup DCPL * * \brief Sets the flag to create minimized dataset object headers * * \dcpl_id * \param[in] minimize Flag for indicating whether or not a dataset's * object header will be minimized * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pset_dset_no_attrs_hint() sets the no dataset attributes * hint setting for the dataset creation property list \p dcpl_id. * Datasets created with the dataset creation property list * \p dcpl_id will have their object headers minimized if the * boolean flag \p minimize is set to TRUE. By setting \p minimize * to TRUE, the library expects that no attributes will be added * to the dataset. Attributes can be added, but they are appended * with a continuation message, which can reduce performance. * * This setting interacts with H5Fset_dset_no_attrs_hint(): if * either is set to TRUE, then the created dataset's object header * will be minimized. * * \since 1.10.5 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pset_dset_no_attrs_hint(hid_t dcpl_id, hbool_t minimize); /** * \ingroup DCPL * * \brief Adds an external file to the list of external files * * \dcpl_id{plist_id} * \param[in] name Name of an external file * \param[in] offset Offset, in bytes, from the beginning of the file to * the location in the file where the data starts * \param[in] size Number of bytes reserved in the file for the data * * \return \herr_t * * \details The first call to H5Pset_external() sets the external * storage property in the property list, thus designating that * the dataset will be stored in one or more non-HDF5 file(s) * external to the HDF5 file. This call also adds the file * \p name as the first file in the list of external files. * Subsequent calls to the function add the named file as the * next file in the list. * * If a dataset is split across multiple files, then the files * should be defined in order. The total size of the dataset is * the sum of the \p size arguments for all the external files. * If the total size is larger than the size of a dataset then * the dataset can be extended (provided the data space also * allows the extending). * * The \p size argument specifies the number of bytes reserved * for data in the external file. If \p size is set to * #H5F_UNLIMITED, the external file can be of unlimited size * and no more files can be added to the external files list. * If \p size is set to 0 (zero), no external file will actually * be created. * * All of the external files for a given dataset must be specified * with H5Pset_external() before H5Dcreate() is called to create * the dataset. If one these files does not exist on the system * when H5Dwrite() is called to write data to it, the library * will create the file. * * \since 1.0.0 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pset_external(hid_t plist_id, const char *name, off_t offset, hsize_t size); /** * \ingroup DCPL * * \brief Sets the time when fill values are written to a dataset * * \dcpl_id{plist_id} * \param[in] fill_time When to write fill values to a dataset * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pset_fill_time() sets up the timing for writing fill values * to a dataset. This property is set in the dataset creation * property list \p plist_id. Timing is specified in \p fill_time * with one of the following values: * * * * * * * * * * * * * * *
#H5D_FILL_TIME_IFSETWrite fill values to the dataset when storage space is * allocated only if there is a user-defined fill value, * i.e.,one set with H5Pset_fill_value(). (Default)
#H5D_FILL_TIME_ALLOCWrite fill values to the dataset when storage space is * allocated.
#H5D_FILL_TIME_NEVERNever write fill values to the dataset.
* * \note H5Pset_fill_time() is designed for coordination with the dataset * fill value and dataset storage allocation time properties, set * with the functions H5Pset_fill_value() and H5Pset_alloc_time(). * See H5Dcreate() for further cross-references. * * \since 1.6.0 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pset_fill_time(hid_t plist_id, H5D_fill_time_t fill_time); /** * \ingroup DCPL * * \brief Sets the fill value for a dataset * * \dcpl_id{plist_id} * \param[in] type_id Datatype of \p value * \param[in] value Pointer to buffer containing value to use as * fill value * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pset_fill_value() sets the fill value for a dataset in the * dataset creation property list. \p value is interpreted as * being of datatype \p type_id. This datatype may differ from * that of the dataset, but the HDF5 library must be able to * convert \p value to the dataset datatype when the dataset is * created. * * The default fill value is 0 (zero), which is interpreted * according to the actual dataset datatype. * * Setting \p value to NULL indicates that the fill value is to * be undefined. * * \note Applications sometimes write data only to portions of an allocated * dataset. It is often useful in such cases to fill the unused space * with a known fill value. This function allows the user application * to set that fill value; the functions H5Dfill() and * H5Pset_fill_time(), respectively, provide the ability to apply the * fill value on demand or to set up its automatic application. * * \note A fill value should be defined so that it is appropriate for the * application. While the HDF5 default fill value is 0 (zero), it is * often appropriate to use another value. It might be useful, for * example, to use a value that is known to be impossible for the * application to legitimately generate. * * \note H5Pset_fill_value() is designed to work in concert with * H5Pset_alloc_time() and H5Pset_fill_time(). H5Pset_alloc_time() * and H5Pset_fill_time() govern the timing of dataset storage * allocation and fill value write operations and can be important in * tuning application performance. * * \note See H5Dcreate() for further cross-references. * * \since 1.0.0 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pset_fill_value(hid_t plist_id, hid_t type_id, const void *value); /** * \ingroup DCPL * * \brief Sets up use of the shuffle filter * * \dcpl_id{plist_id} * * \return \herr_t * * \par_compr_note * * \details H5Pset_shuffle() sets the shuffle filter, #H5Z_FILTER_SHUFFLE, * in the dataset creation property list \p plist_id. The shuffle * filter de-interlaces a block of data by reordering the bytes. * All the bytes from one consistent byte position of each data * element are placed together in one block; all bytes from a * second consistent byte position of each data element are placed * together a second block; etc. For example, given three data * elements of a 4-byte datatype stored as 012301230123, shuffling * will re-order data as 000111222333. This can be a valuable step * in an effective compression algorithm because the bytes in each * byte position are often closely related to each other and * putting them together can increase the compression ratio. * * As implied above, the primary value of the shuffle filter lies * in its coordinated use with a compression filter; it does not * provide data compression when used alone. When the shuffle * filter is applied to a dataset immediately prior to the use of * a compression filter, the compression ratio achieved is often * superior to that achieved by the use of a compression filter * without the shuffle filter. * * \since 1.6.0 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pset_shuffle(hid_t plist_id); /** * \ingroup DCPL * * \brief Sets the type of storage used to store the raw data for a dataset * * \dcpl_id{plist_id} * \param[in] layout Type of storage layout for raw data * * \return \herr_t * \details H5Pset_layout() sets the type of storage used to store the raw * data for a dataset. This function is only valid for dataset * creation property lists. * * Valid values for \p layout are: * - #H5D_COMPACT: Store raw data in the dataset object header * in file. This should only be used for datasets * with small amounts of raw data. The raw data * size limit is 64K (65520 bytes). Attempting * to create a dataset with raw data larger than * this limit will cause the H5Dcreate() call to * fail. * - #H5D_CONTIGUOUS: Store raw data separately from the object * header in one large chunk in the file. * - #H5D_CHUNKED: Store raw data separately from the object header * as chunks of data in separate locations in * the file. * - #H5D_VIRTUAL: Draw raw data from multiple datasets in * different files. * * Note that a compact storage layout may affect writing data to * the dataset with parallel applications. See the note in * H5Dwrite() documentation for details. * \version 1.10.0 #H5D_VIRTUAL added in this release. * \since 1.0.0 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pset_layout(hid_t plist_id, H5D_layout_t layout); /** * \ingroup DCPL * * \brief Sets up the use of the N-Bit filter * * \dcpl_id{plist_id} * * \return \herr_t * * \par_compr_note * * \details H5Pset_nbit() sets the N-Bit filter, #H5Z_FILTER_NBIT, in the * dataset creation property list \p plist_id. * * The HDF5 user can create an N-Bit datatype with the following * code: *
 *          hid_t nbit_datatype = H5Tcopy(H5T_STD_I32LE);
 *          H5Tset_precision(nbit_datatype, 16);
 *          H5Tset_offset(nbit_datatype, 4);
 *          
* * In memory, one value of the N-Bit datatype in the above example * will be stored on a little-endian machine as follows: * * * * * * * * * * * * * * *
byte 3byte 2byte 1byte 0
???????? ????SPPP PPPPPPPP PPPP????
* Note: S - sign bit, P - significant bit, ? - padding bit; For * signed integer, the sign bit is included in the precision. * * When data of the above datatype is stored on disk using the * N-bit filter, all padding bits are chopped off and only * significant bits are stored. The values on disk will be * something like: * * * * * * * * * * * * *
1st value2nd value...
SPPPPPPPPPPPPPPPSPPPPPPPPPPPPPPP...
* The N-Bit filter is used effectively for compressing data of * an N-Bit datatype as well as a compound and an array * datatype with N-Bit fields. However, the datatype classes of * the N-Bit datatype or the N-Bit field of the compound * datatype or the array datatype are limited to integer or * floating-point. * * The N-Bit filter supports complex situations where a compound * datatype contains member(s) of a compound datatype or an array * datatype that has a compound datatype as the base type. * However, it does not support the situation where an array * datatype has a variable-length or variable-length string as * its base datatype. The filter does support the situation where * a variable-length or variable-length string is a member of a * compound datatype. * * The N-Bit filter allows all other HDF5 datatypes (such as * time, string, bitfield, opaque, reference, enum, and variable * length) to pass through as a no-op. * * Like other I/O filters supported by the HDF5 library, * application using the N-Bit filter must store data with * chunked storage. * * By nature, the N-Bit filter should not be used together with * other I/O filters. * * \version 1.8.8 Fortran subroutine introduced in this release. * * \since 1.8.0 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pset_nbit(hid_t plist_id); /** * \ingroup DCPL * * \brief Sets up the use of the scale-offset filter * * \dcpl_id{plist_id} * \param[in] scale_type Flag indicating compression method * \param[in] scale_factor Parameter related to scale. Must be * non-negative * * \return \herr_t * * \par_compr_note * * \details H5Pset_scaleoffset() sets the scale-offset filter, * #H5Z_FILTER_SCALEOFFSET, for a dataset. * * Generally speaking, scale-offset compression performs a scale and/or * offset operation on each data value and truncates the resulting * value to a minimum number of bits (MinBits) before storing it. The * current scale-offset filter supports integer and floating-point * datatypes. * * For an integer datatype, the parameter \p scale_type should be set * to #H5Z_SO_INT (2). The parameter \p scale_factor denotes MinBits. * If the user sets it to H5Z_SO_INT_MINBITS_DEFAULT (0), the filter * will calculate MinBits. If \p scale_factor is set to a positive * integer, the filter does not do any calculation and just uses the * number as MinBits. However, if the user gives a MinBits that is less * than what would be generated by the filter, the compression will be * lossy. Also, the MinBits supplied by the user cannot exceed the * number of bits to store one value of the dataset datatype. * * For a floating-point datatype, the filter adopts the GRiB data * packing mechanism, which offers two alternate methods: E-scaling and * D-scaling. Both methods are lossy compression. If the parameter * \p scale_type is set to #H5Z_SO_FLOAT_DSCALE (0), the filter will * use the D-scaling method; if it is set to #H5Z_SO_FLOAT_ESCALE (1), * the filter will use the E-scaling method. Since only the D-scaling * method is implemented, \p scale_type should be set to * #H5Z_SO_FLOAT_DSCALE or 0. * * When the D-scaling method is used, the original data is "D" scaled * — multiplied by 10 to the power of \p scale_factor, and the * "significant" part of the value is moved to the left of the decimal * point. Care should be taken in setting the decimal \p scale_factor * so that the integer part will have enough precision to contain the * appropriate information of the data value. For example, if * \p scale_factor is set to 2, the number 104.561 will be 10456.1 * after "D" scaling. The last digit 1 is not "significant" and is * thrown off in the process of rounding. The user should make sure that * after "D" scaling and rounding, the data values are within the range * that can be represented by the integer (same size as the * floating-point type). * * Valid values for scale_type are as follows: * * * * * * * * * * * * * * *
#H5Z_SO_FLOAT_DSCALE (0)Floating-point type, using variable MinBits method
#H5Z_SO_FLOAT_ESCALE (1)Floating-point type, using fixed MinBits method
#H5Z_SO_INT (2)Integer type
* * The meaning of \p scale_factor varies according to the value * assigned to \p scale_type: * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * *
\p scale_type value\p scale_factor description
#H5Z_SO_FLOAT_DSCALEDenotes the decimal scale factor for D-scaling and can be * positive, negative or zero. This is the current * implementation of the library.
#H5Z_SO_FLOAT_ESCALEDenotes MinBits for E-scaling and must be a positive integer. * This is not currently implemented by the library.
#H5Z_SO_INTDenotes MinBits and it should be a positive integer or * #H5Z_SO_INT_MINBITS_DEFAULT (0). If it is less than 0, the * library will reset it to 0 since it is not implemented. *
* Like other I/O filters supported by the HDF5 library, an * application using the scale-offset filter must store data with * chunked storage. * * \version 1.8.8 Fortran90 subroutine introduced in this release. * * \since 1.8.0 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pset_scaleoffset(hid_t plist_id, H5Z_SO_scale_type_t scale_type, int scale_factor); /** * \ingroup DCPL * * \brief Sets up use of the SZIP compression filter * * \dcpl_id{plist_id} * \param[in] options_mask A bit-mask conveying the desired SZIP options; * Valid values are #H5_SZIP_EC_OPTION_MASK and * #H5_SZIP_NN_OPTION_MASK. * \param[in] pixels_per_block The number of pixels or data elements in each * data block * * \return \herr_t * * \par_compr_note * * \details H5Pset_szip() sets an SZIP compression filter, #H5Z_FILTER_SZIP, * for a dataset. SZIP is a compression method designed for use with * scientific data. * * Before proceeding, all users should review the “Limitations” * section below. * * Users familiar with SZIP outside the HDF5 context may benefit * from reviewing the Note “For Users Familiar with SZIP in Other * Contexts” below. * * In the text below, the term pixel refers to an HDF5 data element. * This terminology derives from SZIP compression's use with image * data, where pixel referred to an image pixel. * * The SZIP \p bits_per_pixel value (see Note, below) is automatically * set, based on the HDF5 datatype. SZIP can be used with atomic * datatypes that may have size of 8, 16, 32, or 64 bits. * Specifically, a dataset with a datatype that is 8-, 16-, 32-, or * 64-bit signed or unsigned integer; char; or 32- or 64-bit float * can be compressed with SZIP. See Note, below, for further * discussion of the the SZIP \p bits_per_pixel setting. * * SZIP options are passed in an options mask, \p options_mask, * as follows. * * * * * * * * * * * * * * *
OptionDescription (Mutually exclusive; select one.)
#H5_SZIP_EC_OPTION_MASKSelects entropy coding method
#H5_SZIP_NN_OPTION_MASKSelects nearest neighbor coding method
* * The following guidelines can be used in determining which * option to select: * * - The entropy coding method, the EC option specified by * #H5_SZIP_EC_OPTION_MASK, is best suited for data that has been * processed. The EC method works best for small numbers. * - The nearest neighbor coding method, the NN option specified * by #H5_SZIP_NN_OPTION_MASK, preprocesses the data then the * applies EC method as above. * * Other factors may affect results, but the above criteria * provides a good starting point for optimizing data compression. * * SZIP compresses data block by block, with a user-tunable block * size. This block size is passed in the parameter * \p pixels_per_block and must be even and not greater than 32, * with typical values being 8, 10, 16, or 32. This parameter * affects compression ratio; the more pixel values vary, the * smaller this number should be to achieve better performance. * * In HDF5, compression can be applied only to chunked datasets. * If \p pixels_per_block is bigger than the total number of * elements in a dataset chunk, H5Pset_szip() will succeed but * the subsequent call to H5Dcreate() will fail; the conflict * can be detected only when the property list is used. * * To achieve optimal performance for SZIP compression, it is * recommended that a chunk's fastest-changing dimension be equal * to N times \p pixels_per_block where N is the maximum number of * blocks per scan line allowed by the SZIP library. In the * current version of SZIP, N is set to 128. * * SZIP compression is an optional HDF5 filter. * * \b Limitations: * * - SZIP compression cannot be applied to compound, array, * variable-length, enumeration, or any other user-defined * datatypes. If an SZIP filter is set in a dataset creation * property list used to create a dataset containing a * non-allowed datatype, the call to H5Dcreate() will fail; the * conflict can be detected only when the property list is used. * - Users should be aware that there are factors that affect one’s * rights and ability to use SZIP compression by reviewing the * SZIP copyright notice. * * \note \b For \b Users \b Familiar \b with \b SZIP \b in \b Other \b Contexts: * * \note The following notes are of interest primarily to those who have * used SZIP compression outside of the HDF5 context. * In non-HDF5 applications, SZIP typically requires that the user * application supply additional parameters: * - \p pixels_in_object, the number of pixels in the object to * be compressed * - \p bits_per_pixel, the number of bits per pixel * - \p pixels_per_scanline, the number of pixels per scan line * * \note These values need not be independently supplied in the HDF5 * environment as they are derived from the datatype and dataspace, * which are already known. In particular, HDF5 sets * \p pixels_in_object to the number of elements in a chunk and * \p bits_per_pixel to the size of the element or pixel datatype. * * \note The following algorithm is used to set \p pixels_per_scanline: * - If the size of a chunk's fastest-changing dimension, size, * is greater than 4K, set \p pixels_per_scanline to 128 times * \p pixels_per_block. * - If size is less than 4K but greater than \p pixels_per_block, * set \p pixels_per_scanline to the minimum of size and 128 * times \p pixels_per_block. * - If size is less than \p pixels_per_block but greater than the * number elements in the chunk, set \p pixels_per_scanline to * the minimum of the number elements in the chunk and 128 times * \p pixels_per_block. * * \note The HDF5 datatype may have precision that is less than the full * size of the data element, e.g., an 11-bit integer can be defined * using H5Tset_precision(). To a certain extent, SZIP can take * advantage of the precision of the datatype to improve compression: * - If the HDF5 datatype size is 24-bit or less and the offset of * the bits in the HDF5 datatype is zero (see H5Tset_offset() or * H5Tget_offset()), the data is the in lowest N bits of the data * element. In this case, the SZIP \p bits_per_pixel is set to the * precision of the HDF5 datatype. * - If the offset is not zero, the SZIP \p bits_per_pixel will be * set to the number of bits in the full size of the data element. * - If the HDF5 datatype precision is 25-bit to 32-bit, the SZIP * \p bits_per_pixel will be set to 32. * - If the HDF5 datatype precision is 33-bit to 64-bit, the SZIP * \p bits_per_pixel will be set to 64. * * \note HDF5 always modifies the options mask provided by the user to set up * usage of RAW_OPTION_MASK, ALLOW_K13_OPTION_MASK, and one of * LSB_OPTION_MASK or MSB_OPTION_MASK, depending on endianness of the * datatype. * * \since 1.6.0 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pset_szip(hid_t plist_id, unsigned options_mask, unsigned pixels_per_block); /** * \ingroup DCPL * * \brief Sets the mapping between virtual and source datasets * * \dcpl_id * \param[in] vspace_id The dataspace identifier with the selection within the * virtual dataset applied, possibly an unlimited selection * \param[in] src_file_name The name of the HDF5 file where the source dataset is * located or a \Code{"."} (period) for a source dataset in the same * file. The file might not exist yet. The name can be specified using * a C-style \c printf statement as described below. * \param[in] src_dset_name The path to the HDF5 dataset in the file specified by * \p src_file_name. The dataset might not exist yet. The dataset name * can be specified using a C-style \c printf statement as described below. * \param[in] src_space_id The source dataset’s dataspace identifier with a * selection applied, possibly an unlimited selection * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pset_virtual() maps elements of the virtual dataset (VDS) * described by the virtual dataspace identifier \p vspace_id to the * elements of the source dataset described by the source dataset * dataspace identifier \p src_space_id. The source dataset is * identified by the name of the file where it is located, * \p src_file_name, and the name of the dataset, \p src_dset_name. * * \par C-style \c printf Formatting Statements: * C-style \c printf formatting allows a pattern to be specified in the name * of a source file or dataset. Strings for the file and dataset names are * treated as literals except for the following substitutions: * * * * * * * * * *
\Code{"%%"}Replaced with a single \Code{"%"} (percent) character.
"%b"Where "" is the virtual dataset dimension axis (0-based) * and \Code{"b"} indicates that the block count of the selection in that * dimension should be used. The full expression (for example, \Code{"%0b"}) * is replaced with a single numeric value when the mapping is evaluated at * VDS access time. Example code for many source and virtual dataset mappings * is available in the "Examples of Source to Virtual Dataset Mapping" * chapter in the * * RFC: HDF5 Virtual Dataset. *
* If the printf form is used for the source file or dataset names, the * selection in the source dataset’s dataspace must be fixed-size. * * \par Source File Resolutions: * When a source dataset residing in a different file is accessed, the * library will search for the source file \p src_file_name as described * below: * \li If \p src_file_name is a \Code{"."} (period) then it refers to the * file containing the virtual dataset. * \li If \p src_file_name is a relative pathname, the following steps are * performed: * - The library will get the prefix(es) set in the environment * variable \c HDF5_VDS_PREFIX and will try to prepend each prefix * to \p src_file_name to form a new \p src_file_name. If the new * \p src_file_name does not exist or if \c HDF5_VDS_PREFIX is not * set, the library will get the prefix set via H5Pset_virtual_prefix() * and prepend it to \p src_file_name to form a new \p src_file_name. * If the new \p src_file_name does not exist or no prefix is being * set by H5Pset_virtual_prefix() then the path of the file containing * the virtual dataset is obtained. This path can be the absolute path * or the current working directory plus the relative path of that * file when it is created/opened. The library will prepend this path * to \p src_file_name to form a new \p src_file_name. * - If the new \p src_file_name does not exist, then the library will * look for \p src_file_name and will return failure/success accordingly. * \li If \p src_file_name is an absolute pathname, the library will first * try to find \p src_file_name. If \p src_file_name does not exist, * \p src_file_name is stripped of directory paths to form a new * \p src_file_name. The search for the new \p src_file_name then follows * the same steps as described above for a relative pathname. See * examples below illustrating how \p src_file_name is stripped to form * a new \p src_file_name. * \par * Note that \p src_file_name is considered to be an absolute pathname when * the following condition is true: * \li For Unix, the first character of \p src_file_name is a slash * (\Code{/}).\n For example, consider a \p src_file_name of * \Code{/tmp/A.h5}. If that source file does not exist, the new * \p src_file_name after stripping will be \Code{A.h5}. * \li For Windows, there are 6 cases: * 1. \p src_file_name is an absolute drive with absolute pathname.\n * For example, consider a \p src_file_name of \Code{/tmp/A.h5}. * If that source file does not exist, the new \p src_file_name * after stripping will be \Code{A.h5}. * 2. \p src_file_name is an absolute pathname without specifying * drive name.\n For example, consider a \p src_file_name of * \Code{/tmp/A.h5}. If that source file does not exist, the new * \p src_file_name after stripping will be \Code{A.h5}. * 3. \p src_file_name is an absolute drive with relative pathname.\n * For example, consider a \p src_file_name of \Code{/tmp/A.h5}. * If that source file does not exist, the new \p src_file_name * after stripping will be \Code{tmp/A.h5}. * 4. \p src_file_name is in UNC (Uniform Naming Convention) format * with server name, share name, and pathname.\n * For example, consider a \p src_file_name of \Code{/tmp/A.h5}. * If that source file does not exist, the new \p src_file_name * after stripping will be \Code{A.h5}. * 5. \p src_file_name is in Long UNC (Uniform Naming Convention) * format with server name, share name, and pathname.\n * For example, consider a \p src_file_name of \Code{/tmp/A.h5}. * If that source file does not exist, the new \p src_file_name * after stripping will be \Code{A.h5}. * 6. \p src_file_name is in Long UNC (Uniform Naming Convention) * format with an absolute drive and an absolute pathname.\n * For example, consider a \p src_file_name of \Code{/tmp/A.h5}. * If that source file does not exist, the new \p src_file_name * after stripping will be \Code{A.h5} * * \see * Virtual Dataset Overview * * \see_virtual * * \version 1.10.2 A change was made to the method of searching for VDS source files. * \since 1.10.0 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pset_virtual(hid_t dcpl_id, hid_t vspace_id, const char *src_file_name, const char *src_dset_name, hid_t src_space_id); /* Dataset access property list (DAPL) routines */ /** * \ingroup DAPL * * \brief Retrieves the values of the append property that is set up in * the dataset access property list * * \dapl_id * \param[in] dims The number of elements for \p boundary * \param[in] boundary The dimension sizes used to determine the boundary * \param[in] func The user-defined callback function * \param[in] udata The user-defined input data * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pget_append_flush() obtains the following information * from the dataset access property list, \p dapl_id. * * \p boundary consists of the sizes set up in the access * property list that are used to determine when a dataset * dimension size hits the boundary. Only at most \p dims * boundary sizes are retrieved, and \p dims will not exceed * the corresponding value that is set in the property list. * * \p func is the user-defined callback function to invoke when * a dataset’s appended dimension size reaches a boundary and * \p udata is the user-defined input data for the callback * function. * * \since 1.10.0 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pget_append_flush(hid_t dapl_id, unsigned dims, hsize_t boundary[], H5D_append_cb_t *func, void **udata); /** * \ingroup DAPL * * \brief Retrieves the raw data chunk cache parameters * * \dapl_id * \param[out] rdcc_nslots Number of chunk slots in the raw data chunk * cache hash table * \param[out] rdcc_nbytes Total size of the raw data chunk cache, in * bytes * \param[out] rdcc_w0 Preemption policy * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pget_chunk_cache() retrieves the number of chunk slots in * the raw data chunk cache hash table, the maximum possible * number of bytes in the raw data chunk cache, and the * preemption policy value. * * These values are retrieved from a dataset access property * list. If the values have not been set on the property list, * then values returned will be the corresponding values from * a default file access property list. * * Any (or all) pointer arguments may be null pointers, in which * case the corresponding data is not returned. * * \since 1.8.3 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pget_chunk_cache(hid_t dapl_id, size_t *rdcc_nslots /*out*/, size_t *rdcc_nbytes /*out*/, double *rdcc_w0 /*out*/); /** * \ingroup DAPL * * \brief Retrieves the prefix for external raw data storage files as set * in the dataset access property list * * \dapl_id * \param[in,out] prefix Dataset external storage prefix in UTF-8 or * ASCII (\em Path and \em filename must be ASCII * on Windows systems.) * \param[in] size Size of prefix buffer in bytes * * \return Returns the size of \p prefix and the prefix string will be * stored in \p prefix if successful. * Otherwise returns a negative value and the contents of \p prefix * will be undefined. * * \details H5Pget_efile_prefix() retrieves the file system path prefix * for locating external files associated with a dataset that * uses external storage. This will be the value set with * H5Pset_efile_prefix() or the HDF5 library’s default. * * The value of \p size is the size in bytes of the prefix, * including the NULL terminator. If the size is unknown, a * preliminary H5Pget_elink_prefix() call with the pointer * \p prefix set to NULL will return the size of the prefix * without the NULL terminator. * * The \p prefix buffer must be allocated by the caller. In a * call that retrieves the actual prefix, that buffer must be * of the size specified in \p size. * * \note See H5Pset_efile_prefix() for a more complete description of * file location behavior and for notes on the use of the * HDF5_EXTFILE_PREFIX environment variable. * * \since 1.10.0, 1.8.17 * */ H5_DLL ssize_t H5Pget_efile_prefix(hid_t dapl_id, char *prefix /*out*/, size_t size); /** * \ingroup DAPL * * \brief Retrieves prefix applied to VDS source file paths * * \dapl_id * \param[out] prefix Prefix applied to VDS source file paths * \param[in] size Size of prefix, including null terminator * * \return If successful, returns a non-negative value specifying the size * in bytes of the prefix without the NULL terminator; otherwise * returns a negative value. * * \details H5Pget_virtual_prefix() retrieves the prefix applied to the * path of any VDS source files traversed. * * When an VDS source file is traversed, the prefix is retrieved * from the dataset access property list \p dapl_id, returned * in the user-allocated buffer pointed to by \p prefix, and * prepended to the filename stored in the VDS virtual file, set * with H5Pset_virtual(). * * The size in bytes of the prefix, including the NULL terminator, * is specified in \p size. If \p size is unknown, a preliminary * H5Pget_virtual_prefix() call with the pointer \p prefix set to * NULL will return the size of the prefix without the NULL * terminator. * * \see_virtual * * \since 1.10.2 * */ H5_DLL ssize_t H5Pget_virtual_prefix(hid_t dapl_id, char *prefix /*out*/, size_t size); /** * \ingroup DAPL * * \brief Returns the maximum number of missing source files and/or datasets * with the printf-style names when getting the extent for an unlimited * virtual dataset * * \dapl_id * \param[out] gap_size Maximum number of the files and/or datasets * allowed to be missing for determining the extent * of an unlimited virtual dataset with printf-style * mappings. (\em Default: 0) * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pget_virtual_printf_gap() returns the maximum number of * missing printf-style files and/or datasets for determining the * extent of an unlimited virtual dataaset, \p gap_size, using * the access property list for the virtual dataset, \p dapl_id. * * The default library value for \p gap_size is 0 (zero). * * \since 1.10.0 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pget_virtual_printf_gap(hid_t dapl_id, hsize_t *gap_size); /** * \ingroup DAPL * * \brief Retrieves the view of a virtual dataset accessed with * \p dapl_id * * \dapl_id * \param[out] view The flag specifying the view of the virtual dataset. * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pget_virtual_view() takes the virtual dataset access property * list, \p dapl_id, and retrieves the flag, \p view, set by the * H5Pset_virtual_view() call. * * \see_virtual * * \since 1.10.0 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pget_virtual_view(hid_t dapl_id, H5D_vds_view_t *view); /** * \ingroup DAPL * * \brief Sets two actions to perform when the size of a dataset’s * dimension being appended reaches a specified boundary * * \dapl_id * \param[in] ndims The number of elements for boundary * \param[in] boundary The dimension sizes used to determine the boundary * \param[in] func The user-defined callback function * \param[in] udata The user-defined input data * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pset_append_flush() sets the following two actions to * perform for a dataset associated with the dataset access * property list \p dapl_id: * * \li Call the callback function \p func set in the property * list * \li Flush the dataset associated with the dataset access * property list * * When a user is appending data to a dataset via H5DOappend() * and the dataset’s newly extended dimension size hits a * specified boundary, the library will perform the first action * listed above. Upon return from the callback function, the * library will then perform the second action listed above and * return to the user. If no boundary is hit or set, the two * actions above are not invoked. * * The specified boundary is indicated by the parameter * \p boundary. It is a 1-dimensional array with \p ndims * elements, which should be the same as the rank of the * dataset’s dataspace. While appending to a dataset along a * particular dimension index via H5Dappend(), the library * determines a boundary is reached when the resulting dimension * size is divisible by \p boundary[index]. A zero value for * \p boundary[index] indicates no boundary is set for that * dimension index. * * The setting of this property will apply only for a chunked * dataset with an extendible dataspace. A dataspace is extendible * when it is defined with either one of the following: * * \li A dataspace with fixed current and maximum dimension sizes * \li A dataspace with at least one unlimited dimension for its * maximum dimension size * * When creating or opening a chunked dataset, the library will * check whether the boundary as specified in the access property * list is set up properly. The library will fail the dataset * create or open if the following conditions are true: * * \li \p ndims, the number of elements for boundary, is not the * same as the rank of the dataset’s dataspace. * \li A non-zero boundary value is specified for a non-extendible * dimension. * * The callback function \p func must conform to the following * prototype: * \snippet H5Dpublic.h H5D_append_cb_t_snip * * The parameters of the callback function, per the above * prototype, are defined as follows: * * \li \p dataset_id is the dataset identifier. * \li \p cur_dims is the dataset’s current dimension sizes when * a boundary is hit. * \li \p user_data is the user-defined input data. * * \since 1.10.0 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pset_append_flush(hid_t dapl_id, unsigned ndims, const hsize_t boundary[], H5D_append_cb_t func, void *udata); /** * \ingroup DAPL * * \brief Sets the raw data chunk cache parameters * * \dapl_id * \param[in] rdcc_nslots The number of chunk slots in the raw data chunk * cache for this dataset. Increasing this value * reduces the number of cache collisions, but * slightly increases the memory used. Due to the * hashing strategy, this value should ideally be a * prime number. As a rule of thumb, this value * should be at least 10 times the number of chunks * that can fit in \p rdcc_nbytes bytes. For maximum * performance, this value should be set * approximately 100 times that number of chunks. * The default value is 521. If the value passed is * #H5D_CHUNK_CACHE_NSLOTS_DEFAULT, then the * property will not be set on \p dapl_id and the * parameter will come from the file access * property list used to open the file. * \param[in] rdcc_nbytes The total size of the raw data chunk cache for * this dataset. In most cases increasing this * number will improve performance, as long as * you have enough free memory. * The default size is 1 MB. If the value passed is * #H5D_CHUNK_CACHE_NBYTES_DEFAULT, then the * property will not be set on \p dapl_id and the * parameter will come from the file access * property list. * \param[in] rdcc_w0 The chunk preemption policy for this dataset. * This must be between 0 and 1 inclusive and * indicates the weighting according to which chunks * which have been fully read or written are * penalized when determining which chunks to flush * from cache. A value of 0 means fully read or * written chunks are treated no differently than * other chunks (the preemption is strictly LRU) * while a value of 1 means fully read or written * chunks are always preempted before other chunks. * If your application only reads or writes data * once, this can be safely set to 1. Otherwise, * this should be set lower, depending on how often * you re-read or re-write the same data. * The default value is 0.75. If the value passed is * #H5D_CHUNK_CACHE_W0_DEFAULT, then the property * will not be set on \p dapl_id and the parameter * will come from the file access property list. * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pset_chunk_cache() sets the number of elements, the total * number of bytes, and the preemption policy value in the raw * data chunk cache on a dataset access property list. After * calling this function, the values set in the property list * will override the values in the file's file access property * list. * * The raw data chunk cache inserts chunks into the cache * by first computing a hash value using the address of a chunk, * then using that hash value as the chunk's index into the table * of cached chunks. The size of this hash table, i.e., and the * number of possible hash values, is determined by the * \p rdcc_nslots parameter. If a different chunk in the cache * has the same hash value, this causes a collision, which * reduces efficiency. If inserting the chunk into cache would * cause the cache to be too big, then the cache is pruned * according to the \p rdcc_w0 parameter. * * \b Motivation: H5Pset_chunk_cache() is used to adjust the chunk * cache parameters on a per-dataset basis, as opposed to a global * setting for the file using H5Pset_cache(). The optimum chunk * cache parameters may vary widely with different data layout and * access patterns, so for optimal performance they must be set * individually for each dataset. It may also be beneficial to * reduce the size of the chunk cache for datasets whose * performance is not important in order to save memory space. * * \b Example \b Usage: The following code sets the chunk cache to * use a hash table with 12421 elements and a maximum size of * 16 MB, while using the preemption policy specified for the * entire file: * \Code{ * H5Pset_chunk_cache(dapl_id, 12421, 16*1024*1024, * H5D_CHUNK_CACHE_W0_DEFAULT);} * * \b Usage \b Notes: The chunk cache size is a property for * accessing a dataset and is not stored with a dataset or a * file. To guarantee the same chunk cache settings each time * the dataset is opened, call H5Dopen() with a dataset access * property list where the chunk cache size is set by calling * H5Pset_chunk_cache() for that property list. The property * list can be used for multiple accesses in the same * application. * * For files where the same chunk cache size will be * appropriate for all or most datasets, H5Pset_cache() can * be called with a file access property list to set the * chunk cache size for accessing all datasets in the file. * * Both methods can be used in combination, in which case * the chunk cache size set by H5Pset_cache() will apply * except for specific datasets where H5Dopen() is called * with dataset property list with the chunk cache size * set by H5Pset_chunk_cache(). * * In the absence of any cache settings, H5Dopen() will * by default create a 1 MB chunk cache for the opened * dataset. If this size happens to be appropriate, no * call will be needed to either function to set the * chunk cache size. * * It is also possible that a change in access pattern * for later access to a dataset will change the * appropriate chunk cache size. * * \since 1.8.3 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pset_chunk_cache(hid_t dapl_id, size_t rdcc_nslots, size_t rdcc_nbytes, double rdcc_w0); /** * \ingroup DAPL * * \brief Sets the external dataset storage file prefix in the dataset * access property list * * \dapl_id * \param[in] prefix Dataset external storage prefix in UTF-8 or ASCII * (Path and filename must be ASCII on Windows systems.) * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pset_efile_prefix() sets the prefix used to locate raw data * files for a dataset that uses external storage. This prefix * can provide either an absolute path or a relative path to the * external files. * * H5Pset_efile_prefix() is used in conjunction with * H5Pset_external() to control the behavior of the HDF5 library * when searching for the raw data files associated with a dataset * that uses external storage: * * \li The default behavior of the library is to search for the * dataset’s external storage raw data files in the same * directory as the HDF5 file which contains the dataset. * \li If the prefix is set to an absolute path, the target * directory will be searched for the dataset’s external * storage raw data files. * \li If the prefix is set to a relative path, the target * directory, relative to the current working directory, will * be searched for the dataset’s external storage raw data * files. * \li If the prefix is set to a relative path that begins with * the special token ${ORIGIN}, that directory, relative to * the HDF5 file containing the dataset, will be searched for * the dataset’s external storage raw data files. * * The HDF5_EXTFILE_PREFIX environment variable can be used to * override the above behavior (the environment variable * supersedes the API call). Setting the variable to a path * string and calling H5Dcreate() or H5Dopen() is the equivalent * of calling H5Pset_efile_prefix() and calling the same create * or open function. The environment variable is checked at the * time of the create or open action and copied so it can be * safely changed after the H5Dcreate() or H5Dopen() call. * * Calling H5Pset_efile_prefix() with \p prefix set to NULL or * the empty string returns the search path to the default. The * result would be the same as if H5Pset_efile_prefix() had never * been called. * * \note If the external file prefix is not an absolute path and the HDF5 * file is moved, the external storage files will also need to be * moved so they can be accessed at the new location. * * \note As stated above, the use of the HDF5_EXTFILE_PREFIX environment * variable overrides any property list setting. * H5Pset_efile_prefix() and H5Pget_efile_prefix(), being property * functions, set and retrieve only the property list setting; they * are unaware of the environment variable. * * \note On Windows, the prefix must be an ASCII string since the Windows * standard C library’s I/O functions cannot handle UTF-8 file names. * * \since 1.10.0, 1.8.17 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pset_efile_prefix(hid_t dapl_id, const char *prefix); /** * \ingroup DAPL * * \brief Sets prefix to be applied to VDS source file paths * * \dapl_id * \param[in] prefix Prefix to be applied to VDS source file paths * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pset_virtual_prefix() sets the prefix to be applied to the * path of any VDS source files traversed. The prefix is prepended * to the filename stored in the VDS virtual file, set with * H5Pset_virtual(). * * The prefix is specified in the user-allocated buffer \p prefix * and set in the dataset access property list \p dapl_id. The * buffer should not be freed until the property list has been * closed. * * \see_virtual * * \since 1.10.2 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pset_virtual_prefix(hid_t dapl_id, const char *prefix); /** * \ingroup DAPL * * \brief Sets the maximum number of missing source files and/or datasets * with the printf-style names when getting the extent of an * unlimited virtual dataset * * \dapl_id * \param[in] gap_size Maximum number of files and/or datasets allowed to * be missing for determining the extent of an * unlimited virtual dataset with printf-style * mappings (Default value: 0) * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pset_virtual_printf_gap() sets the access property list for * the virtual dataset, \p dapl_id, to instruct the library to * stop looking for the mapped data stored in the files and/or * datasets with the printf-style names after not finding * \p gap_size files and/or datasets. The found source files and * datasets will determine the extent of the unlimited virtual * dataset with the printf-style mappings. * * Consider the following examples where the regularly spaced * blocks of a virtual dataset are mapped to datasets with the * names d-1, d-2, d-3, ..., d-N, ... : * * \li If the dataset d-2 is missing and \p gap_size is set to 0, * then the virtual dataset will contain only data found * in d-1. * \li If d-2 and d-3 are missing and \p gap_size is set to 2, * then the virtual dataset will contain the data from * d-1, d-3, ..., d-N, ... . The blocks that are mapped to * d-2 and d-3 will be filled according to the virtual * dataset’s fill value setting. * * \see_virtual * * \since 1.10.0 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pset_virtual_printf_gap(hid_t dapl_id, hsize_t gap_size); /** * \ingroup DAPL * * \brief Sets the view of the virtual dataset (VDS) to include or exclude * missing mapped elements * * \dapl_id * \param[in] view Flag specifying the extent of the data to be included * in the view. * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pset_virtual_view() takes the access property list for the * virtual dataset, \p dapl_id, and the flag, \p view, and sets * the VDS view according to the flag value. * * If \p view is set to #H5D_VDS_FIRST_MISSING, the view includes * all data before the first missing mapped data. This setting * provides a view containing only the continuous data starting * with the dataset’s first data element. Any break in * continuity terminates the view. * * If \p view is set to #H5D_VDS_LAST_AVAILABLE, the view * includes all available mapped data. * * Missing mapped data is filled with the fill value set in the * VDS creation property list. * * \see_virtual * * \since 1.10.0 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pset_virtual_view(hid_t dapl_id, H5D_vds_view_t view); /* Dataset xfer property list (DXPL) routines */ /** * * \ingroup DXPL * * \brief Gets B-tree split ratios for a dataset transfer property list * * \dxpl_id{plist_id} * \param[out] left The B-tree split ratio for left-most nodes * \param[out] middle The B-tree split ratio for right-most nodes and lone nodes * \param[out] right The B-tree split ratio for all other nodes * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pget_btree_ratios() returns the B-tree split ratios for a dataset * transfer property list. * * The B-tree split ratios are returned through the non-NULL arguments * \p left, \p middle, and \p right, as set by the H5Pset_btree_ratios() * function. * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pget_btree_ratios(hid_t plist_id, double *left /*out*/, double *middle /*out*/, double *right /*out*/); /** * * \ingroup DXPL * * \brief Reads buffer settings * * \param[in] plist_id Identifier for the dataset transfer property list * \param[out] tconv Address of the pointer to application-allocated type * conversion buffer * \param[out] bkg Address of the pointer to application-allocated * background buffer * * \return Returns buffer size, in bytes, if successful; otherwise 0 on failure. * * \details H5Pget_buffer() reads values previously set with H5Pset_buffer(). * * \version 1.6.0 The return type changed from \p hsize_t to \p size_t. * \version 1.4.0 The return type changed to \p hsize_t. * */ H5_DLL size_t H5Pget_buffer(hid_t plist_id, void **tconv /*out*/, void **bkg /*out*/); /** * * \ingroup DXPL * * \brief Retrieves a data transform expression * * \param[in] plist_id Identifier of the property list or class * \param[out] expression Pointer to memory where the transform expression will * be copied * \param[in] size Number of bytes of the transform expression to copy * to * * \return Success: the size of the transform expression. Failure: a negative * value. * * \details H5Pget_data_transform() retrieves the data transform expression * previously set in the dataset transfer property list \p plist_id * by H5Pset_data_transform(). * * H5Pget_data_transform() can be used to both retrieve the transform * expression and query its size. * * If \p expression is non-NULL, up to \p size bytes of the data * transform expression are written to the buffer. If \p expression * is NULL, \p size is ignored, and the function does not write * anything to the buffer. The function always returns the size of * the data transform expression. * * If 0 is returned for the size of the expression, no data transform * expression exists for the property list. * * If an error occurs, the buffer pointed to by \p expression is * unchanged, and the function returns a negative value. * * \since 1.8.0 * */ H5_DLL ssize_t H5Pget_data_transform(hid_t plist_id, char *expression /*out*/, size_t size); /** * * \ingroup DXPL * * \brief Determines whether error-detection is enabled for dataset reads * * \param[in] plist_id Dataset transfer property list identifier * * \return Returns \p H5Z_ENABLE_EDC or \p H5Z_DISABLE_EDC if successful; * otherwise returns a negative value. * * \details H5Pget_edc_check() queries the dataset transfer property * list \p plist to determine whether error detection is enabled for * data read operations. * * \since 1.6.0 * */ H5_DLL H5Z_EDC_t H5Pget_edc_check(hid_t plist_id); /** * * \ingroup DXPL * * \brief Retrieves number of I/O vectors to be read/written in hyperslab I/O * * \param[in] fapl_id Dataset transfer property list identifier * \param[out] size Number of I/O vectors to accumulate in memory for I/O operations * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pget_hyper_vector_size() retrieves the number of I/O vectors to be accumulated in * memory before being issued to the lower levels of the HDF5 library for reading or * writing the actual data. * * The number of I/O vectors set in the dataset transfer property list \p fapl_id is * returned in \p size. Unless the default value is in use, \p size was * previously set with a call to H5Pset_hyper_vector_size(). * * \since 1.6.0 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pget_hyper_vector_size(hid_t fapl_id, size_t *size /*out*/); /** * * \ingroup DXPL * * \brief Checks status of the dataset transfer property list (\b DEPRECATED) * * \deprecated{H5Pget_preserve() is deprecated as it is no longer useful; * compound datatype field preservation is now core functionality * in the HDF5 library.} * * \param[in] plist_id Identifier for the dataset transfer property list * * \return Returns 1 or 0 if successful; otherwise returns a negative value. * * \details H5Pget_preserve() checks the status of the dataset transfer * property list. * * \since 1.0.0 * * \version 1.6.0 The flag parameter was changed from INTEGER to LOGICAL to * better match the C API. (Fortran 90) * \version 1.8.2 Deprecated. * */ H5_DLL int H5Pget_preserve(hid_t plist_id); /** * * \ingroup DXPL * * \brief Gets user-defined datatype conversion callback function * * \param[in] dxpl_id Dataset transfer property list identifier * \param[out] op User-defined type conversion callback function * \param[out] operate_data User-defined input data for the callback function * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pget_type_conv_cb() gets the user-defined datatype conversion * callback function \p op in the dataset transfer property list * \p dxpl_id. * * The parameter \p operate_data is a pointer to user-defined input * data for the callback function. * * The callback function \p op defines the actions an application is * to take when there is an exception during datatype conversion. * * Please refer to the function H5Pset_type_conv_cb() for more details. * * \since 1.8.0 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pget_type_conv_cb(hid_t dxpl_id, H5T_conv_except_func_t *op, void **operate_data); /** * * \ingroup DXPL * * \brief Gets the memory manager for variable-length datatype allocation in H5Dread() and H5Dvlen_reclaim() * * \param[in] plist_id Identifier for the dataset transfer property list * \param[out] alloc_func User's allocate routine, or NULL for system malloc * \param[out] alloc_info Extra parameter for user’s allocation routine. * Contents are ignored if preceding * parameter is NULL \param[out] free_func User's free routine, or NULL for * system free \param[out] free_info * Extra parameter for user’s free routine. Contents are ignored if preceding * parameter is NULL * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pget_vlen_mem_manager() is the companion function to * H5Pset_vlen_mem_manager(), returning the parameters set by * that function. * * \since 1.0.0 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pget_vlen_mem_manager(hid_t plist_id, H5MM_allocate_t *alloc_func, void **alloc_info, H5MM_free_t *free_func, void **free_info); /** * * \ingroup DXPL * * \brief Sets B-tree split ratios for a dataset transfer property list * * \param[in] plist_id The dataset transfer property list identifier * \param[in] left The B-tree split ratio for left-most nodes * \param[in] middle The B-tree split ratio for all other nodes * \param[in] right The B-tree split ratio for right-most nodes and lone * nodes * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pset_btree_ratios() sets the B-tree split ratios for a dataset * transfer property list. The split ratios determine what percent of * children go in the first node when a node splits. * * The ratio \p left is used when the splitting node is the left-most * node at its level in the tree; * the ratio \p right is used when the splitting node is the right-most * node at its level; and * the ratio \p middle is used for all other cases. * * A node that is the only node at its level in the tree uses the * ratio \p right when it splits. * * All ratios are real numbers between 0 and 1, inclusive. * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pset_btree_ratios(hid_t plist_id, double left, double middle, double right); /** * * \ingroup DXPL * * \brief Sets type conversion and background buffers * * \dxpl_id{plist_id} * \param[in] size Size, in bytes, of the type conversion and background buffers * \param[in] tconv Pointer to application-allocated type conversion buffer * \param[in] bkg Pointer to application-allocated background buffer * \return \herr_t * * \details Given a dataset transfer property list, H5Pset_buffer() sets the * maximum size for the type conversion buffer and background buffer * and optionally supplies pointers to application-allocated * buffers. If the buffer size is smaller than the entire amount of * data being transferred between the application and the file, and a * type conversion buffer or background buffer is required, then strip * mining will be used. * * Note that there are minimum size requirements for the buffer. Strip * mining can only break the data up along the first dimension, so the * buffer must be large enough to accommodate a complete slice that * encompasses all of the remaining dimensions. For example, when strip * mining a \Code{100x200x300} hyperslab of a simple data space, the * buffer must be large enough to hold \Code{1x200x300} data * elements. When strip mining a \Code{100x200x300x150} hyperslab of a * simple data space, the buffer must be large enough to hold * \Code{1x200x300x150} data elements. * * If \p tconv and/or \p bkg are null pointers, then buffers will be * allocated and freed during the data transfer. * * The default value for the maximum buffer is 1 MiB. * * \version 1.6.0 The \p size parameter has changed from type hsize_t to \c size_t. * \version 1.4.0 The \p size parameter has changed to type hsize_t. * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pset_buffer(hid_t plist_id, size_t size, void *tconv, void *bkg); /** * \ingroup DXPL * * \brief Sets a data transform expression * * \dxpl_id{plist_id} * \param[in] expression Pointer to the null-terminated data transform * expression * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pset_data_transform() sets the data transform to be used for * reading and writing data. This function operates on the dataset * transfer property list \p plist_id. * * The \p expression parameter is a string containing an algebraic * expression, such as \Code{(5/9.0)*(x-32)} or \Code{x*(x-5)}. When a * dataset is read or written with this property list, the transform * expression is applied with the \c x being replaced by the values in * the dataset. When reading data, the values in the file are not * changed and the transformed data is returned to the user. * * Data transforms can only be applied to integer or * floating-point datasets. Order of operations is obeyed and * the only supported operations are +, -, *, and /. Parentheses * can be nested arbitrarily and can be used to change precedence. * When writing data back to the dataset, the transformed data is * written to the file and there is no way to recover the original * values to which the transform was applied. * * \since 1.8.0 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pset_data_transform(hid_t plist_id, const char *expression); /** * \ingroup DXPL * * \brief Sets the dataset transfer property list to enable or disable error * detection when reading data * * \dxpl_id{plist_id} * \param[in] check Specifies whether error checking is enabled or disabled * for dataset read operations * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pset_edc_check() sets the dataset transfer property list \p plist * to enable or disable error detection when reading data. * * Whether error detection is enabled or disabled is specified in the * \p check parameter. Valid values are #H5Z_ENABLE_EDC (default) and * #H5Z_DISABLE_EDC. * * \note The initial error detection implementation, Fletcher32 checksum, * supports error detection for chunked datasets only. * * \attention The Fletcher32 EDC checksum filter, set with H5Pset_fletcher32(), * was added in HDF5 Release 1.6.0. In the original implementation, * however, the checksum value was calculated incorrectly on * little-endian systems. The error was fixed in HDF5 Release 1.6.3.\n * As a result of this fix, an HDF5 library of Release 1.6.0 through * Release 1.6.2 cannot read a dataset created or written with * Release 1.6.3 or later if the dataset was created with the * checksum filter and the filter is enabled in the reading * library. (Libraries of Release 1.6.3 and later understand the * earlier error and compensate appropriately.)\n * \Bold{Work-around:} An HDF5 library of Release 1.6.2 or earlier * will be able to read a dataset created or written with the * checksum filter by an HDF5 library of Release 1.6.3 or later if * the checksum filter is disabled for the read operation. This can * be accomplished via an H5Pset_edc_check() call with the value * #H5Z_DISABLE_EDC in the second parameter. This has the obvious * drawback that the application will be unable to verify the * checksum, but the data does remain accessible. * * \version 1.6.3 Error in checksum calculation on little-endian systems * corrected in this release. * \since 1.6.0 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pset_edc_check(hid_t plist_id, H5Z_EDC_t check); /** * \ingroup DXPL * * \brief Sets user-defined filter callback function * * \dxpl_id{plist_id} * \param[in] func User-defined filter callback function * \param[in] op_data User-defined input data for the callback function * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pset_filter_callback() sets the user-defined filter callback * function \p func in the dataset transfer property list \p plist_id. * * The parameter \p op_data is a pointer to user-defined input data for * the callback function and will be passed through to the callback * function. * * The callback function \p func defines the actions an application is * to take when a filter fails. The function prototype is as follows: * \snippet H5Zpublic.h H5Z_filter_func_t_snip * where \c filter indicates which filter has failed, \c buf and \c buf_size * are used to pass in the failed data, and op_data is the required * input data for this callback function. * * Valid callback function return values are #H5Z_CB_FAIL and #H5Z_CB_CONT. * * \since 1.6.0 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pset_filter_callback(hid_t plist_id, H5Z_filter_func_t func, void *op_data); /** * \ingroup DXPL * * \brief Sets number of I/O vectors to be read/written in hyperslab I/O * * \dxpl_id{plist_id} * \param[in] size Number of I/O vectors to accumulate in memory for I/O * operations\n * Must be greater than 1 (one)\n * Default value: 1024 * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pset_hyper_vector_size() sets the number of I/O vectors to be * accumulated in memory before being issued to the lower levels of * the HDF5 library for reading or writing the actual data. * * The I/O vectors are hyperslab offset and length pairs and are * generated during hyperslab I/O. * * The number of I/O vectors is passed in \p size to be set in the * dataset transfer property list \p plist_id. \p size must be * greater than 1 (one). * * H5Pset_hyper_vector_size() is an I/O optimization function; * increasing vector_size should provide better performance, but the * library will use more memory during hyperslab I/O. The default value * of \p size is 1024. * * \since 1.6.0 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pset_hyper_vector_size(hid_t plist_id, size_t size); /** * \ingroup DXPL * * \brief Sets the dataset transfer property list \p status * * \dxpl_id{plist_id} * \param[in] status Status toggle of the dataset transfer property list * \return \herr_t * * \deprecated This function is deprecated as it no longer has any effect; * compound datatype field preservation is now core functionality in * the HDF5 library. * * \details H5Pset_preserve() sets the dataset transfer property list status to * \c 1 or \c 0. * * When reading or writing compound datatypes and the destination is * partially initialized and the read/write is intended to initialize * the other members, one must set this property to \c 1. Otherwise the * I/O pipeline treats the destination datapoints as completely * uninitialized. * * \since 1.0.0 * * \version 1.8.2 Deprecated. * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pset_preserve(hid_t plist_id, hbool_t status); /** * \ingroup DXPL * * \brief Sets user-defined datatype conversion callback function * * \dxpl_id * \param[in] op User-defined type conversion callback function * \param[in] operate_data User-defined input data for the callback function * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pset_type_conv_cb() sets the user-defined datatype conversion * callback function \p op in the dataset transfer property list \p * dxpl_id * * The parameter operate_data is a pointer to user-defined input data * for the callback function and will be passed through to the callback * function. * * The callback function \p op defines the actions an application is to * take when there is an exception during datatype conversion. The * function prototype is as follows: * \snippet H5Tpublic.h H5T_conv_except_func_t_snip * * \since 1.8.0 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pset_type_conv_cb(hid_t dxpl_id, H5T_conv_except_func_t op, void *operate_data); /** * \ingroup DXPL * * \brief Sets the memory manager for variable-length datatype allocation in * H5Dread() and H5Dvlen_reclaim() * * \dxpl_id{plist_id} * \param[in] alloc_func User's allocate routine, or \c NULL for system \c malloc * \param[in] alloc_info Extra parameter for user's allocation routine. * Contents are ignored if preceding parameter is \c NULL. * \param[in] free_func User's free routine, or \c NULL for system \c free * \param[in] free_info Extra parameter for user's free routine. Contents are * ignored if preceding parameter is \c NULL * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pset_vlen_mem_manager() sets the memory manager for * variable-length datatype allocation in H5Dread() and free in * H5Dvlen_reclaim(). * * The \p alloc_func and \p free_func parameters identify the memory * management routines to be used. If the user has defined custom * memory management routines, \p alloc_func and/or free_func should be * set to make those routine calls (i.e., the name of the routine is * used as the value of the parameter); if the user prefers to use the * system's \c malloc and/or \c free, the \p alloc_func and \p * free_func parameters, respectively, should be set to \c NULL * * The prototypes for these user-defined functions are as follows: * \snippet H5MMpublic.h H5MM_allocate_t_snip * * \snippet H5MMpublic.h H5MM_free_t_snip * * The \p alloc_info and \p free_info parameters can be used to pass * along any required information to the user's memory management * routines. * * In summary, if the user has defined custom memory management * routines, the name(s) of the routines are passed in the \p * alloc_func and \p free_func parameters and the custom routines' * parameters are passed in the \p alloc_info and \p free_info * parameters. If the user wishes to use the system \c malloc and \c * free functions, the \p alloc_func and/or \p free_func parameters are * set to \c NULL and the \p alloc_info and \p free_info parameters are * ignored. * * \since 1.0.0 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pset_vlen_mem_manager(hid_t plist_id, H5MM_allocate_t alloc_func, void *alloc_info, H5MM_free_t free_func, void *free_info); #ifdef H5_HAVE_PARALLEL /** * \ingroup DXPL * * \brief Retrieves the type of chunk optimization that HDF5 actually performed * on the last parallel I/O call (not necessarily the type requested) * * \dxpl_id{plist_id} * \param[out] actual_chunk_opt_mode The type of chunk optimization performed by HDF5 * \return \herr_t * * \par Motivation: * A user can request collective I/O via a data transfer property list * (DXPL) that has been suitably modified with H5Pset_dxpl_mpio(). * However, HDF5 will sometimes ignore this request and perform independent * I/O instead. This property allows the user to see what kind of I/O HDF5 * actually performed. Used in conjunction with H5Pget_mpio_actual_io_mode(), * this property allows the user to determine exactly what HDF5 did when * attempting collective I/O. * * \details H5Pget_mpio_actual_chunk_opt_mode() retrieves the type of chunk * optimization performed when collective I/O was requested. This * property is set before I/O takes place, and will be set even if I/O * fails. * * Valid values returned in \p actual_chunk_opt_mode: * \snippet this H5D_mpio_actual_chunk_opt_mode_t_snip * \click4more * * \since 1.8.8 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pget_mpio_actual_chunk_opt_mode(hid_t plist_id, H5D_mpio_actual_chunk_opt_mode_t *actual_chunk_opt_mode); /** * \ingroup DXPL * * \brief Retrieves the type of I/O that HDF5 actually performed on the last * parallel I/O call (not necessarily the type requested) * * \dxpl_id{plist_id} * \param[out] actual_io_mode The type of I/O performed by this process * \return \herr_t * * \par Motivation: * A user can request collective I/O via a data transfer property list * (DXPL) that has been suitably modified with H5Pset_dxpl_mpio(). * However, HDF5 will sometimes ignore this request and perform independent * I/O instead. This property allows the user to see what kind of I/O HDF5 * actually performed. Used in conjunction with H5Pget_mpio_actual_chunk_opt_mode(), * this property allows the user to determine exactly HDF5 did when * attempting collective I/O. * * \details H5Pget_mpio_actual_io_mode() retrieves the type of I/O performed on * the selection of the current process. This property is set after all * I/O is completed; if I/O fails, it will not be set. * * Valid values returned in \p actual_io_mode: * \snippet this H5D_mpio_actual_io_mode_t_snip * \click4more * * \attention All processes do not need to have the same value. For example, if * I/O is being performed using the multi chunk optimization scheme, * one process's selection may include only chunks accessed * collectively, while another may include chunks accessed * independently. In this case, the first process will report * #H5D_MPIO_CHUNK_COLLECTIVE while the second will report * #H5D_MPIO_CHUNK_INDEPENDENT. * * \see H5Pget_mpio_no_collective_cause(), H5Pget_mpio_actual_chunk_opt_mode() * * \since 1.8.8 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pget_mpio_actual_io_mode(hid_t plist_id, H5D_mpio_actual_io_mode_t *actual_io_mode); /** * \ingroup DXPL * * \brief Retrieves local and global causes that broke collective I/O on the last * parallel I/O call * * \dxpl_id{plist_id} * \param[out] local_no_collective_cause An enumerated set value indicating the * causes that prevented collective I/O in the local process * \param[out] global_no_collective_cause An enumerated set value indicating * the causes across all processes that prevented collective I/O * \return \herr_t * * \par Motivation: * A user can request collective I/O via a data transfer property list (DXPL) * that has been suitably modified with H5P_SET_DXPL_MPIO. However, there are * conditions that can cause HDF5 to forgo collective I/O and perform * independent I/O. Such causes can be different across the processes of a * parallel application. This function allows the user to determine what * caused the HDF5 library to skip collective I/O locally, that is in the * local process, and globally, across all processes. * * \details H5Pget_mpio_no_collective_cause() serves two purposes. It can be * used to determine whether collective I/O was used for the last * preceding parallel I/O call. If collective I/O was not used, the * function retrieves the local and global causes that broke collective * I/O on that parallel I/O call. The properties retrieved by this * function are set before I/O takes place and are retained even when * I/O fails. * * Valid values returned in \p local_no_collective_cause and \p * global_no_collective_cause are as follows or, if there are multiple * causes, a bitwise OR of the relevant causes; the numbers in the * center column are the bitmask values: * \snippet this H5D_mpio_no_collective_cause_t_snip * \click4more * * \attention Each process determines whether it can perform collective I/O and * broadcasts the result. Those results are combined to make a * collective decision; collective I/O will be performed only if all * processes can perform collective I/O.\n * If collective I/O was not used, the causes that prevented it are * reported by individual process by means of an enumerated set. The * causes may differ among processes, so H5Pget_mpio_no_collective_cause() * returns two property values. The first value is the one produced * by the local process to report local causes. This local information * is encoded in an enumeration, the \ref H5D_mpio_no_collective_cause_t * described above, with all individual causes combined into a single * enumeration value by means of a bitwise OR operation. The second * value reports global causes; this global value is the result of a * bitwise-OR operation across the values returned by all the processes. * * \since 1.8.10 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pget_mpio_no_collective_cause(hid_t plist_id, uint32_t *local_no_collective_cause, uint32_t *global_no_collective_cause); #endif /* H5_HAVE_PARALLEL */ /** * * \ingroup DXPL * * \brief Sets a hyperslab file selection for a dataset I/O operation * * \param[in] plist_id Property list identifier * \param[in] rank Number of dimensions of selection * \param[in] op Operation to perform on current selection * \param[in] start Offset of start of hyperslab * \param[in] stride Hyperslab stride * \param[in] count Number of blocks included in hyperslab * \param[in] block Size of block in hyperslab * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pset_dataset_io_hyperslab_selection() is designed to be used * in conjunction with using #H5S_PLIST for the file dataspace * ID when making a call to H5Dread() or H5Dwrite(). When used * with #H5S_PLIST, the selection created by one or more calls to * this routine is used for determining which dataset elements to * access. * * \p rank is the dimensionality of the selection and determines * the size of the \p start, \p stride, \p count, and \p block arrays. * \p rank must be between 1 and #H5S_MAX_RANK, inclusive. * * The \p op, \p start, \p stride, \p count, and \p block parameters * behave identically to their behavior for H5Sselect_hyperslab(), * please see the documentation for that routine for details about * their use. * * \since 1.13.0 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pset_dataset_io_hyperslab_selection(hid_t plist_id, unsigned rank, H5S_seloper_t op, const hsize_t start[], const hsize_t stride[], const hsize_t count[], const hsize_t block[]); /** * \ingroup LCPL * * \brief Determines whether property is set to enable creating missing * intermediate groups * * \lcpl_id{plist_id} * \param[out] crt_intmd Flag specifying whether to create intermediate * groups upon creation of an object * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pget_create_intermediate_group() determines whether the link * creation property list \p plist_id is set to allow functions * that create objects in groups different from the current * working group to create intermediate groups that may be * missing in the path of a new or moved object. * * Functions that create objects in or move objects to a group * other than the current working group make use of this * property. H5Gcreate_anon() and H5Lmove() are examples of such * functions. * * If \p crt_intmd is positive, missing intermediate groups will * be created; if \p crt_intmd is non-positive, missing intermediate * groups will not be created. * * \since 1.8.0 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pget_create_intermediate_group(hid_t plist_id, unsigned *crt_intmd /*out*/); /** * \ingroup LCPL * * \brief Specifies in property list whether to create missing * intermediate groups * * \lcpl_id{plist_id} * \param[in] crt_intmd Flag specifying whether to create intermediate * groups upon the creation of an object * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pset_create_intermediate_group() * * \since * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pset_create_intermediate_group(hid_t plist_id, unsigned crt_intmd); /* Group creation property list (GCPL) routines */ /** * \ingroup GCPL * * \brief Returns the estimated link count and average link name length in a group * * \gcpl_id{plist_id} * \param[out] est_num_entries The estimated number of links in the group * referenced by \p plist_id * \param[out] est_name_len The estimated average length of line names in the group * referenced by \p plist_id * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pget_est_link_info() retrieves two settings from the group creation * property list \p plist_id: the estimated number of links that are * expected to be inserted into a group created with the property list * and the estimated average length of those link names. * * The estimated number of links is returned in \p est_num_entries. The * limit for \p est_num_entries is 64 K. * * The estimated average length of the anticipated link names is returned * in \p est_name_len. The limit for \p est_name_len is 64 K. * * See \ref_group_impls for a discussion of the available types of HDF5 * group structures. * * \since 1.8.0 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pget_est_link_info(hid_t plist_id, unsigned *est_num_entries /* out */, unsigned *est_name_len /* out */); /** * \ingroup GCPL * * \brief Queries whether link creation order is tracked and/or indexed in * a group * * \param[in] plist_id Group or file creation property list * identifier * \param[out] crt_order_flags Creation order flag(s) * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pget_link_creation_order() queries the group or file creation * property list, \p plist_id, and returns a flag indicating whether * link creation order is tracked and/or indexed in a group. * * See H5Pset_link_creation_order() for a list of valid creation * order flags, as passed in \p crt_order_flags, and their * meanings. * * \since 1.8.0 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pget_link_creation_order(hid_t plist_id, unsigned *crt_order_flags /* out */); /** * \ingroup GCPL * * \brief Queries the settings for conversion between compact and dense * groups * * \gcpl_id{plist_id} * \param[out] max_compact Maximum number of links for compact storage * \param[out] min_dense Minimum number of links for dense storage * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pget_link_phase_change() queries the maximum number of * entries for a compact group and the minimum number of links * to require before converting a group to a dense form. * * In the compact format, links are stored as messages in the * group’s header. In the dense format, links are stored in a * fractal heap and indexed with a version 2 B-tree. * * \p max_compact is the maximum number of links to store as * header messages in the group header before converting the * group to the dense format. Groups that are in the compact * format and exceed this number of links are automatically * converted to the dense format. * * \p min_dense is the minimum number of links to store in the * dense format. Groups which are in dense format and in which * the number of links falls below this number are automatically * converted back to the compact format. * * In the compact format, links are stored as messages in the * group’s header. In the dense format, links are stored in a * fractal heap and indexed with a version 2 B-tree. * * See H5Pset_link_phase_change() for a discussion of * traditional, compact, and dense group storage. * * \since 1.8.0 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pget_link_phase_change(hid_t plist_id, unsigned *max_compact /*out*/, unsigned *min_dense /*out*/); /** * \ingroup GCPL * * \brief Retrieves the anticipated size of the local heap for original-style * groups * * \gcpl_id{plist_id} * \param[out] size_hint Anticipated size of local heap * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pget_local_heap_size_hint() queries the group creation property * list, \p plist_id, for the anticipated size of the local heap, \p * size_hint, for original-style groups, i.e., for groups of the style * used prior to HDF5 Release 1.8.0. See H5Pset_local_heap_size_hint() * for further discussion. * * \since 1.8.0 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pget_local_heap_size_hint(hid_t plist_id, size_t *size_hint /*out*/); /** * \ingroup GCPL * * \brief Sets estimated number of links and length of link names in a group * * \gcpl_id{plist_id} * \param[in] est_num_entries Estimated number of links to be inserted into group * \param[in] est_name_len Estimated average length of link names * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pset_est_link_info() inserts two settings into the group creation * property list plist_id: the estimated number of links that are * expected to be inserted into a group created with the property list * and the estimated average length of those link names. * * The estimated number of links is passed in \p est_num_entries. The * limit for \p est_num_entries is 64 K. * * The estimated average length of the anticipated link names is passed * in \p est_name_len. The limit for \p est_name_len is 64 K. * * The values for these two settings are multiplied to compute the * initial local heap size (for old-style groups, if the local heap * size hint is not set) or the initial object header size for * (new-style compact groups; see \ref_group_impls). Accurately setting * these parameters will help reduce wasted file space. * * If a group is expected to have many links and to be stored in dense * format, set \p est_num_entries to 0 (zero) for maximum * efficiency. This will prevent the group from being created in the * compact format. * * See \ref_group_impls for a discussion of the available types of HDF5 * group structures. * * \since 1.8.0 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pset_est_link_info(hid_t plist_id, unsigned est_num_entries, unsigned est_name_len); /** * \ingroup GCPL * * \brief Sets creation order tracking and indexing for links in a group * * \param[in] plist_id Group or file creation property list * identifier * \param[out] crt_order_flags Creation order flag(s) * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pset_link_creation_order() sets flags for tracking and * indexing links on creation order in groups created with the * group (or file) creation property list \p plist_id. * * \p crt_order_flags contains flags with the following meanings: * * * * * * * * * * *
#H5P_CRT_ORDER_TRACKEDLink creation order is tracked but not necessarily * indexed
#H5P_CRT_ORDER_INDEXEDLink creation order is indexed (requires * #H5P_CRT_ORDER_TRACKED)
* * The default behavior is that links are tracked and indexed by * name, and link creation order is neither tracked nor indexed. * The name is always the primary index for links in a group. * * H5Pset_link_creation_order() can be used to set link creation * order tracking, or to set link creation order tracking and * indexing. * * If (#H5P_CRT_ORDER_TRACKED | #H5P_CRT_ORDER_INDEXED) is * specified for \p crt_order_flags, then links will be tracked * and indexed by creation order. The creation order is added as * a secondary index and enables faster queries and iterations * by creation order. * * If just #H5P_CRT_ORDER_TRACKED is specified for * \p crt_order_flags, then links will be tracked by creation * order, but not indexed by creation order. Queries and iterations * by creation order will work but will be much slower for large * groups than if #H5P_CRT_ORDER_INDEXED had been included. * * \note If a creation order index is to be built, it must be specified in * the group creation property list. HDF5 currently provides no * mechanism to turn on link creation order tracking at group * creation time and to build the index later. * * \since 1.8.0 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pset_link_creation_order(hid_t plist_id, unsigned crt_order_flags); /** * \ingroup GCPL * * \brief Sets the parameters for conversion between compact and dense * groups * * \gcpl_id{plist_id} * \param[in] max_compact Maximum number of links for compact storage * (\a Default: 8) * \param[in] min_dense Minimum number of links for dense storage * (\a Default: 6) * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pset_link_phase_change() sets the maximum number of entries * for a compact group and the minimum number of links to allow * before converting a dense group back to the compact format. * * \p max_compact is the maximum number of links to store as * header messages in the group header before converting the * group to the dense format. Groups that are in compact format * and which exceed this number of links are automatically * converted to dense format. * * \p min_dense is the minimum number of links to store in the * dense format. Groups which are in dense format and in which * the number of links falls below this threshold are * automatically converted to compact format. * * \since 1.8.0 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pset_link_phase_change(hid_t plist_id, unsigned max_compact, unsigned min_dense); /** * \ingroup GCPL * * \brief Specifies the anticipated maximum size of a local heap * * \gcpl_id{plist_id} * \param[in] size_hint Anticipated maximum size in bytes of local heap * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pset_local_heap_size_hint() is used with original-style HDF5 * groups (see “Motivation” below) to specify the anticipated maximum * local heap size, size_hint, for groups created with the group * creation property list \p plist_id. The HDF5 library then uses \p * size_hint to allocate contiguous local heap space in the file for * each group created with \p plist_id. * * For groups with many members or very few members, an appropriate * initial value of \p size_hint would be the anticipated number of * group members times the average length of group member names, plus a * small margin: * \code * size_hint = max_number_of_group_members * * (average_length_of_group_member_link_names + 2) * \endcode * If it is known that there will be groups with zero members, the use * of a group creation property list with \p size_hint set to to 1 (one) * will guarantee the smallest possible local heap for each of those groups. * * Setting \p size_hint to zero (0) causes the library to make a * reasonable estimate for the default local heap size. * * \par Motivation: * In situations where backward-compatibility is required, specifically, when * libraries prior to HDF5 Release 1.8.0 may be used to read the file, groups * must be created and maintained in the original style. This is HDF5’s default * behavior. If backward compatibility with pre-1.8.0 libraries is not a concern, * greater efficiencies can be obtained with the new-format compact and indexed * groups. See Group * implementations in HDF5 in the \ref H5G API introduction (at the bottom).\n * H5Pset_local_heap_size_hint() is useful for tuning file size when files * contain original-style groups with either zero members or very large * numbers of members.\n * The original style of HDF5 groups, the only style available prior to HDF5 * Release 1.8.0, was well-suited for moderate-sized groups but was not optimized * for either very small or very large groups. This original style remains the * default, but two new group implementations were introduced in HDF5 Release 1.8.0: * compact groups to accommodate zero to small numbers of members and indexed groups * for thousands or tens of thousands of members ... or millions, if that's what * your application requires.\n * The local heap size hint, \p size_hint, is a performance tuning parameter for * original-style groups. As indicated above, an HDF5 group may have zero, a handful, * or tens of thousands of members. Since the original style of HDF5 groups stores the * metadata for all of these group members in a uniform format in a local heap, the size * of that metadata (and hence, the size of the local heap) can vary wildly from group * to group. To intelligently allocate space and to avoid unnecessary fragmentation of * the local heap, it can be valuable to provide the library with a hint as to the local * heap’s likely eventual size. This can be particularly valuable when it is known that * a group will eventually have a great many members. It can also be useful in conserving * space in a file when it is known that certain groups will never have any members. * * \since 1.8.0 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pset_local_heap_size_hint(hid_t plist_id, size_t size_hint); /* Map access property list (MAPL) routines */ #ifdef H5_HAVE_MAP_API /** * \ingroup MAPL * * \brief Set map iteration hints * * \mapl_id * \param[in] key_prefetch_size Number of keys to prefetch at a time during * iteration * \param[in] key_alloc_size The initial size of the buffer allocated to hold * prefetched keys * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pset_map_iterate_hints() adjusts the behavior of H5Miterate() when * prefetching keys for iteration. The \p key_prefetch_size parameter * specifies the number of keys to prefetch at a time during * iteration. The \p key_alloc_size parameter specifies the initial * size of the buffer allocated to hold these prefetched keys. If this * buffer is too small it will be reallocated to a larger size, though * this may result in an additional I/O. * * \since 1.12.0 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pset_map_iterate_hints(hid_t mapl_id, size_t key_prefetch_size, size_t key_alloc_size); /** * \ingroup MAPL * * \brief Set map iteration hints * * \mapl_id * \param[out] key_prefetch_size Pointer to number of keys to prefetch at a time * during iteration * \param[out] key_alloc_size Pointer to the initial size of the buffer allocated * to hold prefetched keys * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pget_map_iterate() returns the map iterate hints, \p key_prefetch_size * and \p key_alloc_size, as set by H5Pset_map_iterate_hints(). * * \since 1.12.0 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pget_map_iterate_hints(hid_t mapl_id, size_t *key_prefetch_size /*out*/, size_t *key_alloc_size /*out*/); #endif /* H5_HAVE_MAP_API */ /** * \ingroup ACPL * * \brief Retrieves the character encoding used to create a link or * attribute name * * \param[in] plist_id Link creation or attribute creation property list * identifier * \param[out] encoding String encoding character set * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pget_char_encoding() retrieves the character encoding used * to encode link or attribute names that are created with the * property list \p plist_id. * * Valid values for \p encoding are defined in H5Tpublic.h and * include the following: * * \csets * * \note H5Pget_char_encoding() retrieves the character set used for an * HDF5 link or attribute name while H5Tget_cset() retrieves the * character set used in a character or string datatype. * * \since 1.8.0 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pget_char_encoding(hid_t plist_id, H5T_cset_t *encoding /*out*/); /** * \ingroup ACPL * * \brief Sets the character encoding used to encode link and attribute * names * * \param[in] plist_id Link creation or attribute creation property list * identifier * \param[in] encoding String encoding character set * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pset_char_encoding() sets the character encoding used for * the names of links (which provide the names by which objects * are referenced) or attributes created with the property list * \p plist_id. * * Valid values for encoding include the following: * \csets * \details For example, if the character set for the property list * \p plist_id is set to #H5T_CSET_UTF8, link names pointing to * objects created with the link creation property list * \p plist_id will be encoded using the UTF-8 character set. * Similarly, names of attributes created with the attribute * creation property list \p plist_id will be encoded as UTF-8. * * ASCII and UTF-8 Unicode are the only currently supported * character encodings. Extended ASCII encodings (for example, * ISO 8859) are not supported. This encoding policy is not * enforced by the HDF5 library. Using encodings other than * ASCII and UTF-8 can lead to compatibility and usability * problems. * * \note H5Pset_char_encoding() sets the character set used for an * HDF5 link or attribute name while H5Tset_cset() sets the * character set used in a character or string datatype. * * \since 1.8.0 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pset_char_encoding(hid_t plist_id, H5T_cset_t encoding); /** * \ingroup LAPL * * \brief Retrieves the external link traversal file access flag from the * specified link access property list * * \lapl_id * \param[out] flags File access flag for link traversal * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pget_elink_acc_flags() retrieves the file access flag used * to open an external link target file from the specified link * access property list. * * Valid values for \p flags include: * \li #H5F_ACC_RDWR - Files opened through external links will * be opened with write access * \li #H5F_ACC_RDONLY - Files opened through external links will * be opened with read-only access * \li #H5F_ACC_DEFAULT - Files opened through external links will * be opened with the same access flag as * the parent file * * The value returned, if it is not #H5F_ACC_DEFAULT, will * override the default access flag, which is the access flag * used to open the parent file. * * Example Usage: * The following code retrieves the external link access flag * settings on the link access property list \p lapl_id into a * local variable: *
 *         unsigned acc_flags;
 *         status = H5Pget_elink_acc_flags(lapl_id, &acc_flags);
 *       
* * \since 1.8.3 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pget_elink_acc_flags(hid_t lapl_id, unsigned *flags); /** * \ingroup LAPL * * \brief Retrieves the external link traversal callback function from the * specified link access property list * * \lapl_id * \param[out] func User-defined external link traversal callback * function * \param[out] op_data User-defined input data for the callback function * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pget_elink_cb() retrieves the user-defined external link * traversal callback function defined in the specified link * access property list. * * The callback function may adjust the file access property * list and file access flag to use when opening a file through * an external link. The callback will be executed by the HDF5 * library immediately before opening the target file. * * Failure Modes: H5Pget_elink_cb() will fail if the link * access property list identifier, \p lapl_id, is invalid. * * An invalid function pointer or data pointer, \p func or * \p op_data respectively, may cause a segmentation fault or an * invalid memory access. * * Example Usage: The following code retrieves the external * link callback settings on the link access property list * \p lapl_id into local variables: *
 *       H5L_elink_traverse_t elink_callback_func;
 *       void *elink_callback_udata;
 *       status = H5Pget_elink_cb (lapl_id, &elink_callback_func,
 *                                 &elink_callback_udata);
 *       
* * \since 1.8.3 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pget_elink_cb(hid_t lapl_id, H5L_elink_traverse_t *func, void **op_data); /** * \ingroup LAPL * * \brief Retrieves the file access property list identifier associated * with the link access property list * * \lapl_id * * \return \hid_t{file access property list} * * \details H5Pget_elink_fapl() retrieves the file access property list * identifier that is set for the link access property list * identifier, \p lapl_id. The library uses this file access * property list identifier to open the target file for the * external link access. When no such identifier is set, this * routine returns #H5P_DEFAULT. * * \see H5Pset_elink_fapl() and H5Lcreate_external(). * * \since 1.8.0 * */ H5_DLL hid_t H5Pget_elink_fapl(hid_t lapl_id); /** * \ingroup LAPL * * \brief Retrieves prefix applied to external link paths * * \lapl_id{plist_id} * \param[out] prefix Prefix applied to external link paths * \param[in] size Size of prefix, including null terminator * * \return If successful, returns a non-negative value specifying the size * in bytes of the prefix without the NULL terminator; otherwise * returns a negative value. * * \details H5Pget_elink_prefix() retrieves the prefix applied to the * path of any external links traversed. * * When an external link is traversed, the prefix is retrieved * from the link access property list \p plist_id, returned in * the user-allocated buffer pointed to by \p prefix, and * prepended to the filename stored in the external link. * * The size in bytes of the prefix, including the NULL terminator, * is specified in \p size. If size is unknown, a preliminary * H5Pget_elink_prefix() call with the pointer \p prefix set to * NULL will return the size of the prefix without the NULL * terminator. * * \since 1.8.0 * */ H5_DLL ssize_t H5Pget_elink_prefix(hid_t plist_id, char *prefix, size_t size); /** * \ingroup LAPL * * \brief Retrieves the maximum number of link traversals * * \lapl_id{plist_id} * \param[out] nlinks Maximum number of links to traverse * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pget_nlinks() retrieves the maximum number of soft or * user-defined link traversals allowed, \p nlinks, before the * library assumes it has found a cycle and aborts the traversal. * This value is retrieved from the link access property list * \p plist_id. * * The limit on the number of soft or user-defined link traversals * is designed to terminate link traversal if one or more links * form a cycle. User control is provided because some files may * have legitimate paths formed of large numbers of soft or * user-defined links. This property can be used to allow * traversal of as many links as desired. * * \since 1.8.0 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pget_nlinks(hid_t plist_id, size_t *nlinks); /** * \ingroup LAPL * * \brief Sets the external link traversal file access flag in a link * access property list * * \lapl_id * \param[in] flags The access flag for external link traversal * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pset_elink_acc_flags() specifies the file access flag to use * to open the target file of an external link. This allows * read-only access of files reached through an external link in * a file opened with write access, or vice-versa. * * Valid values for \p flags include: * \li #H5F_ACC_RDWR - Causes files opened through external links * to be opened with write access * \li #H5F_ACC_RDONLY - Causes files opened through external * links to be opened with read-only access * \li #H5F_ACC_DEFAULT - Removes any external link file access * flag setting from \p lapl_id, causing the file access flag * setting to be taken from the parent file * * The library will normally use the file access flag used to * open the parent file as the file access flag for the target * file. This function provides a way to override that behavior. * The external link traversal callback function set by * H5Pset_elink_cb() can override the setting from * H5Pset_elink_acc_flags(). * * Motivation: H5Pset_elink_acc_flags() is used to adjust the * file access flag used to open files reached through external links. * This may be useful to, for example, prevent modifying files * accessed through an external link. Otherwise, the target file is * opened with whatever flag was used to open the parent. * * Example Usage: The following code sets the link access * property list \p lapl_id to open external link target files with * read-only access: *
 *         status = H5Pset_elink_acc_flags(lapl_id, H5F_ACC_RDONLY);
 *        
* * \since 1.8.3 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pset_elink_acc_flags(hid_t lapl_id, unsigned flags); /** * \ingroup LAPL * * \brief Sets the external link traversal callback function in a link * access property list * * \lapl_id * \param[in] func User-defined external link traversal callback * function * \param[in] op_data User-defined input data for the callback function * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pset_elink_cb() sets a user-defined external link traversal * callback function in the link access property list \p lapl_id. * The callback function \p func must conform to the prototype * specified in #H5L_elink_traverse_t. * * The callback function may adjust the file access property * list and file access flags to use when opening a file through * an external link. The callback will be executed by the HDF5 * library immediately before opening the target file. * * The callback will be made after the file access property list * set by H5Pset_elink_fapl() and the file access flag set by * H5Pset_elink_acc_flags() are applied, so changes made by this * callback function will take precedence. * * \attention A file close degree property setting (H5Pset_fclose_degree()) * in this callback function or an associated property list will * be ignored. A file opened by means of traversing an external * link is always opened with the weak file close degree * property setting, #H5F_CLOSE_WEAK. * * Motivation: H5Pset_elink_cb() is used to specify a * callback function that is executed by the HDF5 library when * traversing an external link. This provides a mechanism to set * specific access permissions, modify the file access property * list, modify the parent or target file, or take any other * user-defined action. This callback function is used in * situations where the HDF5 library's default behavior is not * suitable. * * Failure Modes: H5Pset_elink_cb() will fail if the link * access property list identifier, \p lapl_id, is invalid or if * the function pointer, \p func, is NULL. * * An invalid function pointer, \p func, will cause a segmentation * fault or other failure when an attempt is subsequently made to * traverse an external link. * * Example Usage: * This example defines a callback function that prints the name * of the target file every time an external link is followed, and * sets this callback function on \p lapl_id. *
 *          herr_t elink_callback(const char *parent_file_name, const char
 *                 *parent_group_name, const char *child_file_name, const char
 *                 *child_object_name, unsigned *acc_flags, hid_t fapl_id, void *op_data) {
 *              puts(child_file_name);
 *              return 0;
 *          }
 *          int main(void) {
 *              hid_t lapl_id = H5Pcreate(H5P_LINK_ACCESS);
 *              H5Pset_elink_cb(lapl_id, elink_callback, NULL);
 *                ...
 *          }
 *          
* * * \since 1.8.3 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pset_elink_cb(hid_t lapl_id, H5L_elink_traverse_t func, void *op_data); /** * \ingroup LAPL * * \brief Sets a file access property list for use in accessing a file * pointed to by an external link * * \lapl_id * \fapl_id * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pset_elink_fapl() sets the file access property list, * \p fapl_id, to be used when accessing the target file of an * external link associated with \p lapl_id. * * \since 1.8.0 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pset_elink_fapl(hid_t lapl_id, hid_t fapl_id); /** * \ingroup LAPL * * \brief Sets prefix to be applied to external link paths * * \lapl_id{plist_id} * \param[in] prefix Prefix to be applied to external link paths * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pset_elink_prefix() sets the prefix to be applied to the * path of any external links traversed. The prefix is prepended * to the filename stored in the external link. * * The prefix is specified in the user-allocated buffer \p prefix * and set in the link access property list \p plist_id. The buffer * should not be freed until the property list has been closed. * * \since 1.8.0 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pset_elink_prefix(hid_t plist_id, const char *prefix); /** * \ingroup LAPL * * \brief Sets maximum number of soft or user-defined link traversals * * \lapl_id{plist_id} * \param[in] nlinks Maximum number of links to traverse * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pset_nlinks() sets the maximum number of soft or user-defined * link traversals allowed, \p nlinks, before the library assumes * it has found a cycle and aborts the traversal. This value is * set in the link access property list \p plist_id. * * The limit on the number of soft or user-defined link traversals * is designed to terminate link traversal if one or more links * form a cycle. User control is provided because some files may * have legitimate paths formed of large numbers of soft or * user-defined links. This property can be used to allow * traversal of as many links as desired. * * \since 1.8.0 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pset_nlinks(hid_t plist_id, size_t nlinks); /* Object copy property list (OCPYPL) routines */ /** * \ingroup OCPYPL * * \brief Adds a path to the list of paths that will be searched in the * destination file for a matching committed datatype * * \param[in] plist_id Object copy property list identifier * \param[in] path The path to be added * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Padd_merge_committed_dtype_path() adds a path, \p path, * which points to a committed datatype, to the current list of * suggested paths stored in the object copy property list * \p plist_id. The search as described in the next paragraph is * effective only if the #H5O_COPY_MERGE_COMMITTED_DTYPE_FLAG is * enabled in the object copy property list via * H5Pset_copy_object(). * * When copying a committed datatype, a dataset with a committed * datatype, or an object with an attribute of a committed * datatype, the default behavior of H5Ocopy() is to search for * a matching committed datatype: *
    *
  1. First search the list of suggested paths in the object * copy property list.
  2. *
  3. Then, if no match has been found, search all the committed * datatypes in the destination file. *
* The default Step 2 in this search process can be changed by * setting a callback function (see H5Pset_mcdt_search_cb()). * * Two datatypes are determined equal if their descriptions are * identical, in a manner similar to H5Tequal(). If either * committed datatype has one or more attributes, then all * attributes must be present in both committed datatypes and they * must be identical. Two attributes are considered identical if * their datatype description, dataspace, and raw data values are * the same. However, if an attribute uses a committed datatype, * that committed datatype’s attributes will not be compared. * * If a match is found, H5Ocopy() will perform the following in * the destination file: * \li For a committed datatype, the library will create a hard * link to the found datatype. * \li For a dataset that uses a committed datatype, the library * will modify the copied dataset to use the found committed * datatype as its datatype. * \li For an object with an attribute of a committed datatype, * the library will modify the copied object’s attribute to * use the found committed datatype as its datatype. * * If no match is found, H5Ocopy() will perform the following in * the destination file: * \li For a committed datatype, the library will copy it as it * would any other object, creating a named committed * datatype at the destination. That is, the library will * create a committed datatype that is accessible in the * file by a unique path. * \li For a dataset that uses a committed datatype, the * library will copy the datatype as an anonymous * committed datatype and use that as the dataset’s * datatype. * \li For an object with an attribute of a committed datatype, * the library will copy the datatype as an anonymous * committed datatype and use that as the attribute’s * datatype. * * \b Motivation: H5Padd_merge_committed_dtype_path() provides a * means to override the default behavior of H5Ocopy() when * #H5O_COPY_MERGE_COMMITTED_DTYPE_FLAG is set in an object * copy property list. * H5Padd_merge_committed_dtype_path() is the mechanism for * suggesting search paths where H5Ocopy() will look for a * matching committed datatype. This can be substantially * faster than the default approach of searching the entire * destination file for a match. * * \b Example \b Usage: This example adds two paths to the object * copy property list. H5Ocopy() will search the two suggested * paths for a match before searching all the committed datatypes * in the destination file. * *
 *     int main(void) {
 *     hid_t ocpypl_id = H5Pcreate(H5P_OBJECT_COPY);
 *
 *        H5Pset_copy_object(ocpypl_id, H5O_COPY_MERGE_COMMITTED_DTYPE_FLAG);
 *        H5Padd_merge_committed_dtype_path(ocpypl_id, "/group/committed_dtypeA");
 *        H5Padd_merge_committed_dtype_path(ocpypl_id, "/group2/committed_dset");
 *        H5Ocopy(...ocpypl_id...);
 *        ...
 *        ...
 *     }
 *     
* * \note H5Padd_merge_committed_dtype_path() will fail if the object * copy property list is invalid. * It will also fail if there is insufficient memory when * duplicating \p path. * * \see * \li H5Ocopy() * \li #H5O_mcdt_search_cb_t * \li H5Padd_merge_committed_dtype_path() * \li H5Pfree_merge_committed_dtype_paths() * \li H5Pget_mcdt_search_cb() * \li H5Pset_copy_object() * \li H5Pset_mcdt_search_cb() * \li \ref_h5ocopy * * \since 1.8.9 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Padd_merge_committed_dtype_path(hid_t plist_id, const char *path); /** * \ingroup OCPYPL * * \brief Clears the list of paths stored in the object copy property list * * \param[in] plist_id Object copy property list identifier * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pfree_merge_committed_dtype_paths() clears the suggested * paths stored in the object copy property list \p plist_id. * These are the suggested paths previously set with * H5Padd_merge_committed_dtype_path(). * * \b Example \b Usage: This example adds a suggested path to the * object copy property list, does the copy, clears the list, and * then adds a new suggested path to the list for another copy. * *
 *       int main(void) {
 *           hid_t ocpypl_id = H5Pcreate(H5P_OBJECT_COPY);
 *
 *           H5Pset_copy_object(ocpypl_id, H5O_COPY_MERGE_COMMITTED_DTYPE_FLAG);
 *           H5Padd_merge_committed_dtype_path(ocpypl_id, "/group/committed_dtypeA");
 *           H5Ocopy(...ocpypl_id...);
 *           ...
 *           ...
 *           H5Pfree_merge_committed_dtype_paths(ocpypl_id);
 *           H5Padd_merge_committed_dtype_path(ocpypl_id, "/group2/committed_dtypeB");
 *           H5Ocopy(...ocpypl_id...);
 *           ...
 *           ...
 *       }
 *       
* * \note H5Pfree_merge_committed_dtype_paths() will fail if the * object copy property list is invalid. * * \see * \li H5Ocopy() * \li #H5O_mcdt_search_cb_t * \li H5Padd_merge_committed_dtype_path() * \li H5Pfree_merge_committed_dtype_paths() * \li H5Pget_mcdt_search_cb() * \li H5Pset_copy_object() * \li H5Pset_mcdt_search_cb() * * \since 1.8.9 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pfree_merge_committed_dtype_paths(hid_t plist_id); /** * \ingroup OCPYPL * * \brief Retrieves the properties to be used when an object is copied * * \param[in] plist_id Object copy property list identifier * \param[out] copy_options Copy option(s) set in the object copy property * list * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pget_copy_object() retrieves the properties currently * specified in the object copy property list \p plist_id, which * will be invoked when a new copy is made of an existing object. * * \p copy_options is a bit map indicating the flags, or * properties, governing object copying that are set in the * property list \p plist_id. * * The available flags are described in H5Pset_copy_object(). * * \since 1.8.0 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pget_copy_object(hid_t plist_id, unsigned *copy_options /*out*/); /** * \ingroup OCPYPL * * \brief Retrieves the callback function from the specified object copy * property list * * \param[in] plist_id Object copy property list identifier * \param[out] func User-defined callback function * \param[out] op_data User-defined data for the callback * function * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pget_mcdt_search_cb() retrieves the user-defined callback * function and the user data that are set via * H5Pset_mcdt_search_cb() in the object copy property list * \p plist_id. * * The callback function will be returned in the parameter \p func * and the user data will be returned in the parameter \p op_data. * * \note H5Pget_mcdt_search_cb() will fail if the object copy property * list is invalid. * * \see * \li H5Ocopy() * \li #H5O_mcdt_search_cb_t * \li H5Padd_merge_committed_dtype_path() * \li H5Pfree_merge_committed_dtype_paths() * \li H5Pget_mcdt_search_cb() * \li H5Pset_copy_object() * \li H5Pset_mcdt_search_cb() * \li \ref_h5ocopy * * \since 1.8.9 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pget_mcdt_search_cb(hid_t plist_id, H5O_mcdt_search_cb_t *func, void **op_data); /** * \ingroup OCPYPL * * \brief Sets properties to be used when an object is copied * * \param[in] plist_id Object copy property list identifier * \param[out] copy_options Copy option(s) to be set * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pset_copy_object() sets properties in the object copy * property list \p plist_id. When an existing object is copied, * that property list will determine how the new copy is created. * * The following flags are available for use in an object copy * property list: * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * *
#H5O_COPY_SHALLOW_HIERARCHY_FLAGCopy only immediate members of a group
* Default behavior, without flag: Recursively * copy all objects in and below the group.
#H5O_COPY_EXPAND_SOFT_LINK_FLAGExpand soft links into new objects
* Default behavior, without flag: Copy soft * links as they are.
#H5O_COPY_EXPAND_EXT_LINK_FLAGExpand external link into new objects
* Default behavior, without flag: Copy external * links as they are.
#H5O_COPY_EXPAND_REFERENCE_FLAGCopy objects that are pointed to by references and * update reference values in destination file
* Default behavior, without flag: Set reference * values in destination file to zero (0)
#H5O_COPY_WITHOUT_ATTR_FLAGCopy object without copying attributes
* Default behavior, without flag: Copy object * with all its attributes
#H5O_COPY_MERGE_COMMITTED_DTYPE_FLAGUse a matching committed datatype in the destination * file when copying a committed datatype, a dataset with * a committed datatype, or an object with an attribute * of committed datatype
* Default behavior without flag: * * \li A committed datatype in the source will be copied to * the destination as a committed datatype. * \li If a dataset in the source uses a committed * datatype or an object in the source has an attribute * of a committed datatype, that committed datatype will * be written to the destination as an anonymous * committed datatype. * If copied in a single H5Ocopy() operation, objects * that share a committed datatype in the source will * share an anonymous committed dataype in the * destination copy. Subsequent H5Ocopy() operations, * however, will be unaware of prior anonymous committed * dataypes and will create new ones. * * See the “See Also” section immediately below for * functions related to the use of this flag.
* * \see * Functions and a callback function used to tune committed datatype * copying behavior: * \li #H5O_mcdt_search_cb_t * \li H5Padd_merge_committed_dtype_path() * \li H5Pfree_merge_committed_dtype_paths() * \li H5Pget_mcdt_search_cb() * \li H5Pset_copy_object() * \li H5Pset_mcdt_search_cb() * \li \ref_h5ocopy * * \version 1.8.9 #H5O_COPY_MERGE_COMMITTED_DTYPE_FLAG added in this release. * * \since 1.8.0 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pset_copy_object(hid_t plist_id, unsigned copy_options); /** * \ingroup OCPYPL * * \brief Sets the callback function that H5Ocopy() will invoke before * searching the entire destination file for a matching committed * datatype * * \param[in] plist_id Object copy property list identifier * \param[in] func User-defined callback function * \param[in] op_data User-defined input data for the callback function * * \return \herr_t * * \details H5Pset_mcdt_search_cb() allows an application to set a * callback function, \p func, that will be invoked before * searching the destination file for a matching committed * datatype. The default, global search process is described in * H5Padd_merge_committed_dtype_path(). * * The callback function must conform to the #H5O_mcdt_search_cb_t * prototype and will return an instruction for one of the * following actions: * * \li Continue the search for a matching committed datatype in * the destination file. * \li Discontinue the search for a matching committed datatype. * H5Ocopy() will then apply the default behavior of creating * an anonymous committed datatype. * \li Abort the copy operation and exit H5Ocopy(). * * \b Motivation: H5Pset_mcdt_search_cb() provides the means to * define a callback function. An application can then use that * callback to take an additional action before the default search * of all committed datatypes in the destination file or to take an * action that replaces the default search. This mechanism is * intended to improve performance when the global search might * take a long time. * * \b Example \b Usage: This example defines a callback function in * the object copy property list. * *
 * static H5O_mcdt_search_ret_t
 * mcdt_search_cb(void *_udata)
 * {
 *     H5O_mcdt_search_ret_t action = *((H5O_mcdt_search_ret_t *)_udata);
 *
 *      return(action);
 *  }
 *
 *  int main(void) {
 *      hid_t ocpypl_id = H5Pcreate(H5P_OBJECT_COPY);
 *
 *      H5Pset_copy_object(ocpypl_id, H5O_COPY_MERGE_COMMITTED_DTYPE_FLAG);
 *      H5Padd_merge_committed_dtype_path(ocpypl_id, "/group/committed_dtypeA");
 *
 *      action = H5O_MCDT_SEARCH_STOP;
 *      H5Pset_mcdt_search_cb(ocpypl_id, mcdt_search_cb, &action);
 *      H5Ocopy(...ocpypl_id...);
 *      ...
 *      ...
 * }
 * 
* * \note H5Pset_mcdt_search_cb() will fail if the * object copy property list is invalid. * * \warning If the callback function return value causes H5Ocopy() to * abort, the destination file may be left in an inconsistent or * corrupted state. * * \see * \li H5Ocopy() * \li #H5O_mcdt_search_cb_t * \li H5Padd_merge_committed_dtype_path() * \li H5Pfree_merge_committed_dtype_paths() * \li H5Pget_mcdt_search_cb() * \li H5Pset_copy_object() * \li H5Pset_mcdt_search_cb() * \li \ref_h5ocopy * * \since 1.8.9 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pset_mcdt_search_cb(hid_t plist_id, H5O_mcdt_search_cb_t func, void *op_data); /* Symbols defined for compatibility with previous versions of the HDF5 API. * * Use of these symbols is deprecated. */ #ifndef H5_NO_DEPRECATED_SYMBOLS /* Macros */ /* We renamed the "root" of the property list class hierarchy */ #define H5P_NO_CLASS H5P_ROOT /* Typedefs */ /** * \ingroup PLCRA * * \brief Registers a permanent property with a property list class * * \plistcls_id{cls_id} * \param[in] name Name of property to register * \param[in] size Size of property in bytes * \param[in] def_value Default value for property in newly created * property lists * \param[in] prp_create Callback routine called when a property list is * being created and the property value will be * initialized * \param[in] prp_set Callback routine called before a new value is * copied into the property's value * \param[in] prp_get Callback routine called when a property value is * retrieved from the property * \param[in] prp_del Callback routine called when a property is deleted * from a property list * \param[in] prp_copy Callback routine called when a property is copied * from a property list * \param[in] prp_close Callback routine called when a property list is * being closed and the property value will be * disposed of * * \return \herr_t * * \deprecated As of HDF5-1.8 this function was deprecated in favor of * H5Pregister2() or the macro H5Pregister(). * * \details H5Pregister1() registers a new property with a property list * class. The property will exist in all property list objects * of that class after this routine is finished. The name of * the property must not already exist. The default property * value must be provided and all new property lists created * with this property will have the property value set to the * default provided. Any of the callback routines may be set * to NULL if they are not needed. * * Zero-sized properties are allowed and do not store any data in * the property list. These may be used as flags to indicate the * presence or absence of a particular piece of information. The * default pointer for a zero-sized property may be set to NULL. * The property \p prp_create and \p prp_close callbacks are called for * zero-sized properties, but the \p prp_set and \p prp_get callbacks * are never called. * * The \p prp_create routine is called when a new property list with * this property is being created. The #H5P_prp_create_func_t * callback function is defined as #H5P_prp_cb1_t. * * The \p prp_create routine may modify the value to be set and those * changes will be stored as the initial value of the property. * If the \p prp_create routine returns a negative value, the new * property value is not copied into the property and the * \p prp_create routine returns an error value. * * The \p prp_set routine is called before a new value is copied into * the property. The #H5P_prp_set_func_t callback function is defined * as #H5P_prp_cb2_t. * * The \p prp_set routine may modify the value pointer to be set and * those changes will be used when setting the property's value. * If the \p prp_set routine returns a negative value, the new property * value is not copied into the property and the \p prp_set routine * returns an error value. The \p prp_set routine will not be called * for the initial value; only the \p prp_create routine will be * called. * * \b Note: The \p prp_set callback function may be useful to range * check the value being set for the property or may perform some * transformation or translation of the value set. The \p prp_get * callback would then reverse the transformation or translation. * A single \p prp_get or \p prp_set callback could handle multiple * properties by performing different actions based on the property * name or other properties in the property list. * * The \p prp_get routine is called when a value is retrieved from a * property value. The #H5P_prp_get_func_t callback function is * defined as #H5P_prp_cb2_t. * * The \p prp_get routine may modify the value to be returned from the * query and those changes will be returned to the calling routine. * If the \p prp_set routine returns a negative value, the query * routine returns an error value. * * The \p prp_del routine is called when a property is being * deleted from a property list. The #H5P_prp_delete_func_t * callback function is defined as #H5P_prp_cb2_t. * * The \p prp_del routine may modify the value passed in, but the * value is not used by the library when the \p prp_del routine * returns. If the \p prp_del routine returns a negative value, * the property list deletion routine returns an error value but * the property is still deleted. * * The \p prp_copy routine is called when a new property list with * this property is being created through a \p prp_copy operation. * The #H5P_prp_copy_func_t callback function is defined as * #H5P_prp_cb1_t. * * The \p prp_copy routine may modify the value to be set and those * changes will be stored as the new value of the property. If * the \p prp_copy routine returns a negative value, the new * property value is not copied into the property and the \p prp_copy * routine returns an error value. * * The \p prp_close routine is called when a property list with this * property is being closed. The #H5P_prp_close_func_t callback * function is defined as #H5P_prp_cb1_t. * * The \p prp_close routine may modify the value passed in, but the * value is not used by the library when the \p prp_close routine * returns. If the \p prp_close routine returns a negative value, the * property list close routine returns an error value but the property * list is still closed. * * The #H5P_prp_cb1_t is as follows: * \snippet this H5P_prp_cb1_t_snip * * The #H5P_prp_cb2_t is as follows: * \snippet this H5P_prp_cb2_t_snip * */ /* Function prototypes */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pregister1(hid_t cls_id, const char *name, size_t size, void *def_value, H5P_prp_create_func_t prp_create, H5P_prp_set_func_t prp_set, H5P_prp_get_func_t prp_get, H5P_prp_delete_func_t prp_del, H5P_prp_copy_func_t prp_copy, H5P_prp_close_func_t prp_close); /** * \ingroup PLCRA * * \brief Registers a temporary property with a property list * * \plist_id * \param[in] name Name of property to create * \param[in] size Size of property in bytes * \param[in] value Initial value for the property * \param[in] prp_set Callback routine called before a new value is copied * into the property's value * \param[in] prp_get Callback routine called when a property value is * retrieved from the property * \param[in] prp_delete Callback routine called when a property is deleted * from a property list * \param[in] prp_copy Callback routine called when a property is copied * from an existing property list * \param[in] prp_close Callback routine called when a property list is * being closed and the property value will be disposed * of * * \return \herr_t * * \deprecated As of HDF5-1.8 this function was deprecated in favor of * H5Pinsert2() or the macro H5Pinsert(). * * \details H5Pinsert1() creates a new property in a property * list. The property will exist only in this property list and * copies made from it. * * The initial property value must be provided in \p value and * the property value will be set accordingly. * * The name of the property must not already exist in this list, * or this routine will fail. * * The \p prp_set and \p prp_get callback routines may be set to NULL * if they are not needed. * * Zero-sized properties are allowed and do not store any data * in the property list. The default value of a zero-size * property may be set to NULL. They may be used to indicate the * presence or absence of a particular piece of information. * * The \p prp_set routine is called before a new value is copied * into the property. The #H5P_prp_set_func_t callback function * is defined as #H5P_prp_cb2_t. * The \p prp_set routine may modify the value pointer to be set and * those changes will be used when setting the property's value. * If the \p prp_set routine returns a negative value, the new property * value is not copied into the property and the \p set routine * returns an error value. The \p prp_set routine will be called for * the initial value. * * \b Note: The \p prp_set callback function may be useful to range * check the value being set for the property or may perform some * transformation or translation of the value set. The \p prp_get * callback would then reverse the transformation or translation. * A single \p prp_get or \p prp_set callback could handle multiple * properties by performing different actions based on the * property name or other properties in the property list. * * The \p prp_get routine is called when a value is retrieved from * a property value. The #H5P_prp_get_func_t callback function * is defined as #H5P_prp_cb2_t. * * The \p prp_get routine may modify the value to be returned from * the query and those changes will be preserved. If the \p prp_get * routine returns a negative value, the query routine returns * an error value. * * The \p prp_delete routine is called when a property is being * deleted from a property list. The #H5P_prp_delete_func_t * callback function is defined as #H5P_prp_cb2_t. * * The \p prp_copy routine is called when a new property list with * this property is being created through a \p prp_copy operation. * The #H5P_prp_copy_func_t callback function is defined as * #H5P_prp_cb1_t. * * The \p prp_copy routine may modify the value to be set and those * changes will be stored as the new value of the property. If the * \p prp_copy routine returns a negative value, the new property value * is not copied into the property and the prp_copy routine returns an * error value. * * The \p prp_close routine is called when a property list with this * property is being closed. * The #H5P_prp_close_func_t callback function is defined as * #H5P_prp_cb1_t. * * The \p prp_close routine may modify the value passed in, the * value is not used by the library when the close routine * returns. If the \p prp_close routine returns a negative value, * the property list \p prp_close routine returns an error value * but the property list is still closed. * * \b Note: There is no \p prp_create callback routine for temporary * property list objects; the initial value is assumed to * have any necessary setup already performed on it. * * The #H5P_prp_cb1_t is as follows: * \snippet this H5P_prp_cb1_t_snip * * The #H5P_prp_cb2_t is as follows: * \snippet this H5P_prp_cb2_t_snip * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pinsert1(hid_t plist_id, const char *name, size_t size, void *value, H5P_prp_set_func_t prp_set, H5P_prp_get_func_t prp_get, H5P_prp_delete_func_t prp_delete, H5P_prp_copy_func_t prp_copy, H5P_prp_close_func_t prp_close); /** * \ingroup PLCRA * * \brief Encodes the property values in a property list into a binary * buffer * * \plist_id * \param[out] buf Buffer into which the property list will be encoded. * If the provided buffer is NULL, the size of the * buffer required is returned through \p nalloc; the * function does nothing more. * \param[out] nalloc The size of the required buffer * * \return \herr_t * * \deprecated As of HDF5-1.12 this function has been deprecated in favor of * H5Pencode2() or the macro H5Pencode(). * * \details H5Pencode1() encodes the property list \p plist_id into the * binary buffer \p buf. * * If the required buffer size is unknown, \p buf can be passed * in as NULL and the function will set the required buffer size * in \p nalloc. The buffer can then be created and the property * list encoded with a subsequent H5Pencode1() call. * * If the buffer passed in is not big enough to hold the encoded * properties, the H5Pencode1() call can be expected to fail with * a segmentation fault. * * Properties that do not have encode callbacks will be skipped. * There is currently no mechanism to register an encode callback for * a user-defined property, so user-defined properties cannot currently * be encoded. * * Some properties cannot be encoded, particularly properties that are * reliant on local context. * * \since 1.10.0 * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pencode1(hid_t plist_id, void *buf, size_t *nalloc); /** * \ingroup DCPL * * \brief Returns information about a filter in a pipeline (DEPRECATED) * * * * \plist_id{plist_id} * \param[in] filter Sequence number within the filter pipeline of * the filter for which information is sought * \param[out] flags Bit vector specifying certain general properties * of the filter * \param[in,out] cd_nelmts Number of elements in \p cd_values * \param[out] cd_values Auxiliary data for the filter * \param[in] namelen Anticipated number of characters in \p name * \param[out] name Name of the filter * * \return Returns the filter identifier if successful; Otherwise returns * a negative value. See: #H5Z_filter_t * * \deprecated When was this function deprecated? * * \details H5Pget_filter1() returns information about a filter, specified * by its filter number, in a filter pipeline, specified by the * property list with which it is associated. * * \p plist_id must be a dataset or group creation property list. * * \p filter is a value between zero and N-1, as described in * H5Pget_nfilters(). The function will return a negative value * if the filter number is out of range. * * The structure of the \p flags argument is discussed in * H5Pset_filter(). * * On input, \p cd_nelmts indicates the number of entries in the * \p cd_values array, as allocated by the caller; on return, * \p cd_nelmts contains the number of values defined by the filter. * * If \p name is a pointer to an array of at least \p namelen * bytes, the filter name will be copied into that array. The name * will be null terminated if \p namelen is large enough. The * filter name returned will be the name appearing in the file, the * name registered for the filter, or an empty string. * * \version 1.8.5 Function extended to work with group creation property * lists. * \version 1.8.0 N-bit and scale-offset filters added. * \version 1.8.0 Function H5Pget_filter() renamed to H5Pget_filter1() and * deprecated in this release. * \version 1.6.4 \p filter parameter type changed to unsigned. * */ H5_DLL H5Z_filter_t H5Pget_filter1(hid_t plist_id, unsigned filter, unsigned int *flags /*out*/, size_t *cd_nelmts /*out*/, unsigned cd_values[] /*out*/, size_t namelen, char name[]); /** * \ingroup DCPL * * \brief Returns information about the specified filter * * \plist_id{plist_id} * \param[in] id Filter identifier * \param[out] flags Bit vector specifying certain general properties * of the filter * \param[in,out] cd_nelmts Number of elements in \p cd_values * \param[out] cd_values Auxiliary data for the filter * \param[in] namelen Anticipated number of characters in \p name * \param[out] name Name of the filter * * * \return Returns a non-negative value if successful; Otherwise returns * a negative value. * * \deprecated As of HDF5-1.8 this function was deprecated in favor of * H5Pget_filter_by_id2() or the macro H5Pget_filter_by_id(). * * \details H5Pget_filter_by_id1() returns information about a filter, specified * in \p id, a filter identifier. * * \p plist_id must be a dataset or group creation property list and * \p id must be in the associated filter pipeline. * * The \p id and \p flags parameters are used in the same * manner as described in the discussion of H5Pset_filter(). * * Aside from the fact that they are used for output, the parameters * \p cd_nelmts and \p cd_values[] are used in the same manner as * described in the discussion of H5Pset_filter(). * On input, the \p cd_nelmts parameter indicates the number of entries * in the \p cd_values[] array allocated by the calling program; * on exit it contains the number of values defined by the filter. * * On input, the \p namelen parameter indicates the number of * characters allocated for the filter name by the calling program * in the array \p name[]. On exit \p name[] contains the name of the * filter with one character of the name in each element of the array. * * If the filter specified in \p id is not set for the property * list, an error will be returned and this function will fail. * * * \version 1.8.5 Function extended to work with group creation property * lists. * \version 1.8.0 Function H5Pget_filter_by_id() renamed to * H5Pget_filter_by_id1() and deprecated in this release. * \version 1.6.0 Function introduced in this release. */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pget_filter_by_id1(hid_t plist_id, H5Z_filter_t id, unsigned int *flags /*out*/, size_t *cd_nelmts /*out*/, unsigned cd_values[] /*out*/, size_t namelen, char name[] /*out*/); /** * \ingroup FCPL * * \brief Retrieves the version information of various objects * for a file creation property list(deprecated) * * \plist_id * \param[out] boot Pointer to location to return super block version number * \param[out] freelist Pointer to location to return global freelist version number * \param[out] stab Pointer to location to return symbol table version number * \param[out] shhdr Pointer to location to return shared object header version * number * * \return \herr_t * * \deprecated Deprecated in favor of the function H5Fget_info() * * \details H5Pget_version() retrieves the version information of various objects * for a file creation property list. Any pointer parameters which are * passed as NULL are not queried. * * \version 1.6.4 \p boot, \p freelist, \p stab, \p shhdr parameter types * changed to unsigned. * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pget_version(hid_t plist_id, unsigned *boot /*out*/, unsigned *freelist /*out*/, unsigned *stab /*out*/, unsigned *shhdr /*out*/); /** * \ingroup FCPL * * \brief Sets the file space handling strategy and the free-space section * size threshold. * * \fcpl_id{plist_id} * \param[in] strategy The file space handling strategy to be used. See: * #H5F_fspace_strategy_t * \param[in] threshold The smallest free-space section size that the free * space manager will track * * \return \herr_t * * \deprecated When was this function deprecated? * * \details Maps to the function H5Pset_file_space_strategy(). * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pset_file_space(hid_t plist_id, H5F_file_space_type_t strategy, hsize_t threshold); /** * \ingroup FCPL * * \brief Retrieves the file space handling strategy, and threshold value for * a file creation property list * * \fcpl_id{plist_id} * \param[out] strategy Pointer to the file space handling strategy * \param[out] threshold Pointer to the free-space section size threshold value * * \return \herr_t * * \deprecated When was this function deprecated? * * \details Maps to the function H5Pget_file_space_strategy() * * */ H5_DLL herr_t H5Pget_file_space(hid_t plist_id, H5F_file_space_type_t *strategy, hsize_t *threshold); #endif /* H5_NO_DEPRECATED_SYMBOLS */ #ifdef __cplusplus } #endif #endif /* H5Ppublic_H */